target: added events TARGET_EVENT_STEP_START and _END
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * TFTP:: TFTP
83 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
84 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
85 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
86 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
87 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
88
89 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
90 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
91 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
92 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
93 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
94 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
95 @end menu
96
97 @node About
98 @unnumbered About
99 @cindex about
100
101 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
102 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
103 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
104 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
105 around the world.
106
107 @section What is OpenOCD?
108 @cindex TAP
109 @cindex JTAG
110
111 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
112 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
113 devices.
114
115 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
116 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
117 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
118 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
119 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
120 needed to hook up to the target.
121
122 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
123 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
124 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
125 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
126 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
127
128 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
129 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
130 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
131 let the development board connect directly to the debug
132 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
133
134 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
135 signaling, and is used to communicate
136 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
137 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
138 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
139 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
140 scan operations.
141
142 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
143 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
144 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
145 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
146
147 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
148 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
149 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
150 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
151
152
153 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
154 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
155 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
156
157 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
158 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
159 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
160 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
161
162 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
163 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
164 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
165 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
166 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
167
168 @section OpenOCD Web Site
169
170 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
171
172 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
173
174 @section Latest User's Guide:
175
176 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
177 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
178 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
179
180 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
181
182 PDF form is likewise published at:
183
184 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
185
186 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
187
188 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
189 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
190 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
191 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
192 instead of this forum.
193
194 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
195
196 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
197
198 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
199 communication between users:
200
201 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
202
203 @section OpenOCD IRC
204
205 Support can also be found on irc:
206 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
207
208 @node Developers
209 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
210 @cindex developers
211
212 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
213 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
214 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
215 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
216
217 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
218 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
219
220 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
221
222 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
223 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
224
225 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
226
227 or via http
228
229 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
230
231 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
232
233 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
234
235 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
236 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
237 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
238 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
239 needing a Git client:
240
241 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
242
243 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
244 from the repository or a snapshot.
245
246 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
247 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
248 Patches created against older versions may require additional
249 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
250
251 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
252
253 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
254 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
255 technical information about the software internals, development
256 processes, and similar documentation:
257
258 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
259
260 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
261 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
262 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
263
264 @section Gerrit Review System
265
266 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
267 Code Review System:
268
269 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
270
271 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
272 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
273 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
274 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
275 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
276
277 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
278 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
279 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
280 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
281 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
282
283 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
284
285 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
286 communication between developers:
287
288 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
289
290 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
291
292 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
293
294 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
295
296
297 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
299 @cindex dongles
300 @cindex FTDI
301 @cindex wiggler
302 @cindex zy1000
303 @cindex printer port
304 @cindex USB Adapter
305 @cindex RTCK
306
307 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
308 an adapter .... [snip]
309
310 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
311 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
312 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
313 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
314 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
315 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
316 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
317
318
319 @section Choosing a Dongle
320
321 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
322
323 @enumerate
324 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
325 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
326 other ways to communicate with target devices.
327 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
328 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
329 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
330 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
331 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
332 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
333 Ethernet port needed?
334 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
335 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
336 @end enumerate
337
338 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
339
340 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
341 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
342 running on the developer's host computer.
343 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
344 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
345 IP address assigned to the probe.
346 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
347 OpenOCD debugger.
348 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
349 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
350 the target.
351 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
352 to power cycle the target remotely.
353
354 For more information, visit:
355
356 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
357
358 @section USB FT2232 Based
359
360 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
361 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
362 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
363 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
364 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
365 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
366 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
367 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
368 clocking.)
369
370 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
371 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
372 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
373 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
374 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
375
376 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
377 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
378
379 @itemize @bullet
380 @item @b{usbjtag}
381 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
382 @item @b{jtagkey}
383 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
384 @item @b{jtagkey2}
385 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
386 @item @b{oocdlink}
387 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
388 @item @b{signalyzer}
389 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
390 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
391 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
392 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
393 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
394 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
395 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
396 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
397 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
398 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
399 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
400 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
401 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
402 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
403 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
404 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
405 @item @b{turtelizer2}
406 @* See:
407 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
408 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
409 @item @b{comstick}
410 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
411 @item @b{stm32stick}
412 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
413 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
414 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
415 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
416 @item @b{cortino}
417 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
418 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
419 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
420 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
421 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
422 @item @b{opendous}
423 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
424 (OpenHardware).
425 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
426 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
427
428 @item @b{GW16042}
429 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
430 FT2232H-based
431
432 @end itemize
433 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
434
435 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
436 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
437 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
438 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
439 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
440
441 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
442 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
443 (see the section on driver commands).
444
445 @itemize
446 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
447 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
448 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB J-Link based
453 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
454 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
455 AT91SAM764 internally.
456
457 @itemize @bullet
458 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
460 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
461 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
462 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
463 @end itemize
464
465 @section USB RLINK based
466 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
467 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
468 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
469
470 @itemize @bullet
471 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
472 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
473 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
474 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
475 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
476 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
477 @end itemize
478
479 @section USB ST-LINK based
480 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
481 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
482
483 @itemize @bullet
484 @item @b{ST-LINK}
485 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
486 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
487 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
488 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
489 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
490 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
491 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
492 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
493 @end itemize
494
495 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
496 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
497 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
498 @itemize @bullet
499 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
500 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
501 @end itemize
502
503 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
504 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
505 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
506 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
507
508 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
509 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
510 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
511
512 @section USB Other
513 @itemize @bullet
514 @item @b{USBprog}
515 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
516
517 @item @b{USB - Presto}
518 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
519
520 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
521 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
522
523 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
524 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
525
526 @item @b{Buspirate}
527 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
528
529 @item @b{opendous}
530 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
531
532 @item @b{estick}
533 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
534
535 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
536 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
537
538 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
539 @* The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
540 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
541 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
542 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
543 @*@deffn {Config Command} {xds110 serial} serial_string
544 Specifies the serial number of which XDS110 probe to use. Otherwise, the first
545 XDS110 found will be used.
546 @end deffn
547 @*@deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
548 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
549 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
550 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
551 @end deffn
552 @*@deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
553 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
554 version).
555 @end deffn
556 @* Further information can be found at the following sites:
557 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
558 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
559 @end itemize
560
561 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
562
563 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
564 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
565 these on the market.
566
567 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
568 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
569 of USB-based ones.
570
571 @itemize @bullet
572
573 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
574 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
575
576 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
577 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
578 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
579
580 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
581 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
582
583 @item @b{Wiggler2}
584 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
585
586 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
587 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
588
589 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
590 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
591
592 @item @b{arm-jtag}
593 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
594
595 @item @b{chameleon}
596 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
597
598 @item @b{Triton}
599 @* Unknown.
600
601 @item @b{Lattice}
602 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
603 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
604
605 @item @b{flashlink}
606 @* From STMicroelectronics;
607 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
608
609 @end itemize
610
611 @section Other...
612 @itemize @bullet
613
614 @item @b{ep93xx}
615 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
616
617 @item @b{at91rm9200}
618 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
619
620 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
621 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
622
623 @item @b{imx_gpio}
624 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
625
626 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
627 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
628 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
629
630 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
631 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG interface.
632
633 @end itemize
634
635 @node About Jim-Tcl
636 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
637 @cindex Jim-Tcl
638 @cindex tcl
639
640 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
641 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
642 command interpreter.
643
644 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
645 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
646 much of anything about Tcl.
647 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
648
649 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
650 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
651 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
652 OpenOCD mailing list.
653
654 @itemize @bullet
655 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
656 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
657 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
658 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
659 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
660 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
661
662 @item @b{Missing Features}
663 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
664 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
665 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
666 enabled in OpenOCD.
667
668 @item @b{Scripts}
669 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
670 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
671 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
672
673 @item @b{Commands}
674 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
675 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
676 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
677 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
678
679 @item @b{Historical Note}
680 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
681 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
682 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
683 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
684
685 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
686 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
687 @end itemize
688
689 @node Running
690 @chapter Running
691 @cindex command line options
692 @cindex logfile
693 @cindex directory search
694
695 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
696 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
697 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
698 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
699 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
700 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
701 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
702
703 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
704 tell it how each debug session should work.
705 The @option{--help} option shows:
706 @verbatim
707 bash$ openocd --help
708
709 --help | -h display this help
710 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
711 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
712 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
713 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
714 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
715 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
716 --command | -c run <command>
717 @end verbatim
718
719 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
720 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
721 To specify one or more different
722 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
723
724 @example
725 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
726 @end example
727
728 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
729 @enumerate
730 @item the current directory,
731 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
732 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
733 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd} (not on Windows),
734 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
735 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
736 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
737 @end enumerate
738 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
739
740 @quotation Note
741 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
742 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
743 @end quotation
744
745 @section Simple setup, no customization
746
747 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
748 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
749 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
750 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
751 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
752
753 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
754 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
755 the server with some variation of one of the following:
756
757 @example
758 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
759 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
760 @end example
761
762 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
763 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
764 If all goes well you'll see output something like
765
766 @example
767 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
768 For bug reports, read
769 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
770 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
771 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
772 @end example
773
774 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
775 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
776 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
777
778 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
779
780 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
781 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
782 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
783 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
784 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
785 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
786 ensure that this always succeeds.
787 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
788 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
789 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
790 and then shut down without acting as a server.
791
792 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
793 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
794 those channels.
795
796 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
797 the @option{-d} option.
798
799 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
800 @option{-c} command line switch.
801
802 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
803 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
804 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
805 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
806 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
807 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
808 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
809
810 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
811 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
812
813 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
814 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
815 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
816 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
817
818 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
819 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
820
821 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
822 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
823 and start the OpenOCD server.
824 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
825 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
826 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
827 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
828
829 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
830
831 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
832 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
833 and a USB cable on the other.
834 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
835 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
836
837 @enumerate
838 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
839 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
840 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
841 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
842 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
843 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
844 debugging host.
845
846 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
847 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
848 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
849 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
850 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
851
852 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
853 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
854 with 1.2 Volt boards.
855
856 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
857 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
858 ways to connect the cable.
859 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
860 Be sure it's firmly connected.
861
862 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
863 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
864 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
865 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
866 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
867 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
868 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
869 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
870
871 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
872 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
873 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
874 but are tedious to set up.
875 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
876 adapter signals to the right board pins.
877
878 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
879 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
880 you are using to run OpenOCD.
881 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
882
883 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
884 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
885 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
886 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
887
888 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
889 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
890 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
891
892 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
893 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
894 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
895 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
896
897 @end enumerate
898
899 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
900 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
901 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
902
903 @section Project Directory
904
905 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
906
907 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
908 single directory for your work with a given board.
909 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
910 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
911 files accessed through semihosting,
912 and for code you upload to the target board.
913 It is also the natural place to write files,
914 such as log files and data you download from the board.
915
916 @section Configuration Basics
917
918 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
919 a variety of ways you can mix them.
920 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
921
922 @itemize
923 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
924 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
925 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
926 @end itemize
927
928 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
929 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
930 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
931
932 @example
933 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
934
935 # GDB can also flash my flash!
936 gdb_memory_map enable
937 gdb_flash_program enable
938
939 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
940 @end example
941
942 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
943
944 @example
945 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
946 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
947 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
948 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
949 @end example
950
951 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
952 each supporting a different development task.
953 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
954 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
955
956 @quotation Important
957 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
958 problems with how it treats variables.
959 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
960 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
961 that can be tested in a later script.
962 @end quotation
963
964 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
965 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
966 to simplify your work.
967
968 @section User Config Files
969 @cindex config file, user
970 @cindex user config file
971 @cindex config file, overview
972
973 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
974 in one place.
975 One of the following will match your situation best:
976
977 @itemize
978 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
979 provided by someone else.
980 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
981 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
982 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
983 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
984 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
985 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
986
987 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
988 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
989
990 @enumerate
991 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
992 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
993 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
994 @end enumerate
995
996 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
997 The first is an interface config file.
998 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
999 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
1000 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
1001 meet your deadline:
1002
1003 @example
1004 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
1005 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
1006 @end example
1007
1008 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
1009 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
1010 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
1011 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
1012
1013 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
1014 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
1015 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
1016 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
1017 target and board
1018 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
1019 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
1020
1021 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
1022 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1023 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1024 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1025
1026 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1027 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1028 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1029 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1030 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1031
1032 @quotation Note
1033 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1034 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1035 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1036 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1037 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1038 @end quotation
1039
1040 @item
1041 You may may need to write some C code.
1042 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1043 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1044 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1045 a new chip architecture.
1046 @end itemize
1047
1048 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1049 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1050 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1051
1052 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1053 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1054 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1055 @itemize
1056
1057 @item
1058 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1059 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1060 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1061 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1062
1063 @item
1064 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1065 @cindex vector_catch
1066 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1067 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1068 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1069 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1070 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1071 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1072
1073 @item
1074 You might need to override some defaults.
1075 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1076 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1077
1078 @item
1079 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1080 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1081 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1082 @end itemize
1083
1084 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1085
1086 A few project-specific utility
1087 routines may well speed up your work.
1088 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1089
1090 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1091 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1092 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1093 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1094 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1095 may help:
1096
1097 @example
1098 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1099 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1100 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1101 # Leave the CPU halted.
1102 reset init
1103
1104 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1105 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1106
1107 # Start running.
1108 resume 0x20000000
1109 @}
1110 @end example
1111
1112 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1113 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1114 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1115 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1116 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1117
1118 @example
1119 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1120 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1121 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1122 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1123 reset init
1124
1125 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1126 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1127 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1128 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1129 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1130 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1131 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1132
1133 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1134 reset run
1135 @}
1136 @end example
1137
1138 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1139 from NAND.
1140 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1141 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1142 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1143
1144 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1145 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1146
1147 @section Target Software Changes
1148
1149 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1150 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1151 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1152 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1153 handling issues like:
1154
1155 @itemize @bullet
1156
1157 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1158 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1159 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1160 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1161 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1162 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1163 your debug sessions.
1164
1165 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1166 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1167 That might however be your only option.
1168
1169 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1170 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1171 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1172 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1173 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1174 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1175 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1176 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1177 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1178 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1179 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1180 instead of the whole thing.
1181 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1182 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1183
1184 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1185 @cindex ARM semihosting
1186 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1187 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1188 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1189 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1190 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1191 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1192 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1193 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1194 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1195 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1196 NAND or SPI flash.
1197
1198 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1199 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1200 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1201 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1202 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1203
1204 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1205 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1206 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1207 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1208 registers which can be used to change various features including
1209 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1210 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1211 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1212 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1213 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1214
1215 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1216 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1217 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1218 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1219 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1220
1221 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1222 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1223 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1224 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1225 early code execution can be debugged
1226 or firmware can be replaced.
1227
1228 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1229 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1230 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1231 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1232 operations like writing to memory.)
1233
1234 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1235 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1236 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1237 various kinds of message.
1238 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1239
1240 @end itemize
1241
1242 @section Target Hardware Setup
1243
1244 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1245 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1246 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1247 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1248 working with.}
1249
1250 Common issues include:
1251
1252 @itemize @bullet
1253
1254 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1255 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1256 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1257 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1258 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1259 or one from a daughtercard).
1260 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1261 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1262
1263 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1264 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1265 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1266 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1267 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1268 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1269
1270 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1271 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1272 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1273 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1274 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1275
1276
1277 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1278 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1279 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1280 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1281 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1282 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1283 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1284
1285 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1286 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1287 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1288 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1289 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1290
1291 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1292 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1293 used to start booting.
1294
1295 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1296 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1297 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1298 multiple audio codec chips).
1299 This interacts with software
1300 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1301 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1302 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1303 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1304 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1305 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1306 audio or video codecs are used.
1307
1308 @end itemize
1309
1310 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1311 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1312 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1313 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1314 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1315 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1316 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1317 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1318 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1319 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1320
1321
1322 @node Config File Guidelines
1323 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1324
1325 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1326 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1327 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1328 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1329
1330 You should find the following directories under
1331 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1332 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1333 @itemize @bullet
1334 @item @file{interface} ...
1335 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1336 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1337 @item @file{board} ...
1338 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1339 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1340
1341 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1342 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1343 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1344 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1345 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1346 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1347 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1348 a CPU and an FPGA.
1349 @item @file{target} ...
1350 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1351 on a chip
1352 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1353 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1354 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1355 the target config file defines all of them.
1356 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1357 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1358 @end itemize
1359
1360 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1361 file may override features in any of the above files by
1362 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1363 commands specific to their situation.
1364
1365 @section Interface Config Files
1366
1367 The user config file
1368 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1369
1370 @example
1371 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1372 @end example
1373
1374 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1375 in use today with OpenOCD.
1376 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1377 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1378
1379 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1380 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1381 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1382 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1383 and need to provide a driver for it.
1384
1385 @section Board Config Files
1386 @cindex config file, board
1387 @cindex board config file
1388
1389 The user config file
1390 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1391
1392 @example
1393 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1394 @end example
1395
1396 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1397 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1398 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1399
1400 @enumerate
1401 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1402 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1403 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1404 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1405 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1406 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1407 @end enumerate
1408
1409 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1410 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1411 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1412 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1413
1414 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1415 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1416 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1417 configuration works.
1418
1419 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1420
1421 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1422 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1423 convention on how to use certain variables.
1424
1425 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1426 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1427 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1428 used at will within a target configuration file.
1429
1430 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1431 for a board with three chips:
1432
1433 @example
1434 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1435 set CHIPNAME network
1436 set ENDIAN big
1437 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1438 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1439 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1440 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1441
1442 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1443 set CHIPNAME video
1444 set ENDIAN little
1445 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1446 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1447 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1448 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1449
1450 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1451 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1452 unset ENDIAN
1453 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1454 @end example
1455
1456 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1457 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1458 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1459 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1460 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1461 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1462 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1463 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1464
1465 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1466 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1467 naming collisions.
1468
1469 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1470 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1471 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1472 up other clocks and peripherals.
1473
1474 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1475 @cindex variable names
1476
1477 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1478 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1479 one such chip (as shown above).
1480 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1481 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1482 to promote consistency and
1483 so that board files can override target defaults.
1484
1485 Inputs to target config files include:
1486
1487 @itemize @bullet
1488 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1489 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1490 tap identifier dotted names.
1491 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1492 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1493 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1494 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1495 Chips that can't change endianess don't need to use this variable.
1496 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1497 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1498 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1499 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1500 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1501 @end itemize
1502
1503 Outputs from target config files include:
1504
1505 @itemize @bullet
1506 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1507 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1508 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1509 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1510 specific to that board and that target.
1511 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1512 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1513 @end itemize
1514
1515 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1516 @cindex event, reset-init
1517 @cindex reset-init handler
1518
1519 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1520 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1521 fully set up yet.
1522 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1523 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1524 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1525 handler is one of the most important.
1526
1527 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1528 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1529 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1530 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1531 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1532
1533 @quotation Note
1534 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1535 are included here.
1536 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1537 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1538 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1539 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1540 @end quotation
1541
1542 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1543 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1544 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1545 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1546 those as parameters.
1547 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1548 and disabling the watchdog.
1549 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1550 the next developer doing such work.
1551 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1552
1553 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1554 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1555 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1556 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1557
1558 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1559
1560 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1561 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1562 a low JTAG clock rate.
1563 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1564 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1565 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1566 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1567 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1568 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1569 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1570
1571 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1572 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1573 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1574 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1575 which might be less than that.
1576
1577 @quotation Warning
1578 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1579 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1580 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1581 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1582 @end quotation
1583
1584 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1585 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1586 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1587 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1588 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1589 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1590
1591 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1592 @subsection The init_board procedure
1593 @cindex init_board procedure
1594
1595 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1596 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1597 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1598 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1599 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1600 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1601 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1602 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1603 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1604 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1605 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1606 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1607
1608 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1609 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1610
1611 @example
1612 ### board_file.cfg ###
1613
1614 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1615 source [find target/target.cfg]
1616
1617 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1618 # enables fast on-board clock source
1619 # configures the chip to use it
1620 @}
1621
1622 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1623 proc init_board @{@} @{
1624 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1625
1626 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1627 adapter speed 100
1628 @}
1629
1630 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1631 enable_fast_clock
1632 adapter speed 10000
1633 @}
1634 @}
1635 @end example
1636
1637 @section Target Config Files
1638 @cindex config file, target
1639 @cindex target config file
1640
1641 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1642 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1643 more target config files like this:
1644
1645 @example
1646 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1647 @end example
1648
1649 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1650 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1651 In summary the target files should contain
1652
1653 @enumerate
1654 @item Set defaults
1655 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1656 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1657 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1658 @item On-Chip flash
1659 @end enumerate
1660
1661 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1662 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1663 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1664
1665 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1666 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1667 can talk to the chip.
1668 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1669 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1670 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1671 and other processing engines.
1672
1673 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1674
1675 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1676 letting board config files express environment-specific
1677 differences in how things should be set up.
1678
1679 @example
1680 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1681 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1682 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1683 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1684 @} else @{
1685 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1686 @}
1687
1688 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1689 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1690 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1691 @} else @{
1692 set _ENDIAN little
1693 @}
1694
1695 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1696 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1697 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1698 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1699 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1700 @} else @{
1701 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1702 @}
1703 @end example
1704 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1705
1706 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1707 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1708 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1709
1710 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1711 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1712 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1713
1714 @example
1715 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1716 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1717 @end example
1718
1719 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1720 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1721 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1722 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1723 for taps.
1724
1725 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1726 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1727 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1728 looks (in part) like this:
1729
1730 @example
1731 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1732 @end example
1733
1734 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1735 to source such a config file twice, with different
1736 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1737 it adds a different TAP each time.
1738
1739 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1740 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1741 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1742 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1743
1744 @example
1745 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1746 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1747 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1748 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1749 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1750 @end example
1751
1752 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1753 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1754
1755 @itemize
1756 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1757 plus a JRC to enable them
1758 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1759 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1760 is not currently used)
1761 @end itemize
1762
1763 @subsection Add CPU targets
1764
1765 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1766 GDB and other commands can use it.
1767 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1768 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1769 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1770 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1771
1772 @example
1773 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1774 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1775 @end example
1776
1777 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1778 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1779 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1780 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1781 a work area if you can.
1782 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1783
1784 @example
1785 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1786 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1787 @end example
1788
1789 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1790 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1791 @cindex SMP
1792 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1793
1794 @example
1795 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1796 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1797 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1798 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1799 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1800 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1801 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1802 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1803 @end example
1804 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1805 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1806 @itemize @bullet
1807 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1808 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1809 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1810 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1811 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1812 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1813 @end itemize
1814
1815 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1816 command have been implemented.
1817 @itemize @bullet
1818 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1819 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1820 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1821 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1822 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1823 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1824 following example.
1825 @end itemize
1826
1827 @example
1828 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1829 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1830 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1831 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1832 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1833 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1834 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1835 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1836 > resume
1837 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1838 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1839 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1840 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1841 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1842 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1843 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1844 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1845 @end example
1846
1847
1848 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1849
1850 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1851 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1852 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1853
1854 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1855 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1856 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1857 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1858 both signals.
1859
1860 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1861 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1862 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1863 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1864 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1865 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1866 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1867 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1868 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1869 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1870 not available.)
1871
1872 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1873 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1874 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1875 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1876 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1877 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1878 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1879 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1880
1881 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1882 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1883 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1884 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1885 slower clock than they will use later.
1886 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1887 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1888 than they will use later.
1889 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1890
1891 @quotation Important
1892 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1893 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1894 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1895 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1896 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1897 @end quotation
1898
1899 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1900 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1901 @cindex init_targets procedure
1902
1903 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1904 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1905 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1906 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1907 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1908 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1909 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1910 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1911 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1912
1913 @example
1914 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1915
1916 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1917 # basic initialization procedure ...
1918 @}
1919
1920 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1921 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1922 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1923 @}
1924
1925 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1926
1927 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1928
1929 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1930 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1931 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1932 @}
1933 @end example
1934
1935 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1936 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1937
1938 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1939
1940 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1941 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1942
1943 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1944 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1945 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1946
1947 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1948 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1949 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1950 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1951 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1952 events already assigned.
1953
1954 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1955
1956 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1957 special high speed download features - enable it.
1958
1959 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1960
1961 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1962 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1963 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1964 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1965 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1966 If you are using an external trace port,
1967 configure it in your board config file.
1968 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1969 configure it in your target config file.
1970
1971 @example
1972 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1973 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1974 @end example
1975
1976 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1977
1978 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1979
1980 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1981 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1982 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1983 the TARGET (chip) file.
1984
1985 Examples:
1986 @itemize @bullet
1987 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1988 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1989 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1990 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1991 @end itemize
1992
1993 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1994 @section Translating Configuration Files
1995 @cindex translation
1996 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1997 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1998 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1999 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
2000 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
2001 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
2002
2003 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
2004 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
2005 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
2006 convert other scripts later on.
2007
2008 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
2009 replace job:
2010
2011 @example
2012 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
2013 #
2014 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
2015 #
2016 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
2017 #
2018 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
2019
2020 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
2021 global TARGETNAME
2022
2023 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2024
2025 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2026 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2027 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2028 @}
2029 @end example
2030
2031
2032
2033 @node Server Configuration
2034 @chapter Server Configuration
2035 @cindex initialization
2036 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2037 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2038 supported.
2039
2040 @anchor{configurationstage}
2041 @section Configuration Stage
2042 @cindex configuration stage
2043 @cindex config command
2044
2045 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2046 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2047 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2048 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2049 inside startup scripts.
2050
2051 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2052 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2053 which may be issued interactively.
2054 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2055 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2056
2057 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2058 flash banks,
2059 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2060 and other basic setup.
2061 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2062 may access or activate TAPs.
2063 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2064 longer be issued.
2065
2066 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2067 @section Entering the Run Stage
2068
2069 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2070 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2071 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2072 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2073 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2074 You should see no errors at this point.
2075 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2076 commands you used to configure the server.
2077 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2078 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2079 on the scan chain.
2080
2081 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2082 become available.
2083 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2084 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2085 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2086 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2087 entry to the run stage.
2088
2089 @deffn {Config Command} init
2090 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2091 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2092 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2093 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2094 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2095 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2096
2097 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2098 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2099 configuration files and/or command line options.
2100
2101 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2102 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2103 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2104 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2105 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2106 @end deffn
2107
2108 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2109 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2110 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2111
2112 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2113 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2114 scan chain.
2115 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2116 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2117
2118 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2119 they return.
2120 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2121 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2122 @end deffn
2123
2124 @anchor{tcpipports}
2125 @section TCP/IP Ports
2126 @cindex TCP port
2127 @cindex server
2128 @cindex port
2129 @cindex security
2130 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2131 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2132 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2133
2134 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2135 access using one or more of these ports.
2136 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2137 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2138 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2139
2140 @anchor{gdb_port}
2141 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2142 @cindex GDB server
2143 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2144 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2145 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2146 the normal use cases.
2147
2148 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2149 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2150 disables the gdb server.
2151
2152 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2153 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2154
2155 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2156 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2157
2158 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2159 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2160 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2161
2162 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2163 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2164 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2165 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2166 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2167 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2168 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2169 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2170 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2171
2172 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2173 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2174 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2175 @end deffn
2176
2177 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2178 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2179 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2180 output from the Tcl engine.
2181 Intended as a machine interface.
2182 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2183 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2184 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2185 @end deffn
2186
2187 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2188 Specify or query the
2189 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2190 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2191 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2192 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2193 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2194 @end deffn
2195
2196 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2197 @section GDB Configuration
2198 @cindex GDB
2199 @cindex GDB configuration
2200 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2201 The ones listed here are static and global.
2202 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2203 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2204
2205 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2206 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2207 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2208 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2209 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2210 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2211 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2212 @end deffn
2213
2214 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2215 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2216 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2217 vFlash packet is received.
2218 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2219 @end deffn
2220
2221 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2222 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2223 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2224 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2225 for flash programming to work.
2226 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2227 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2228 @end deffn
2229
2230 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2231 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2232 by GDB memory read packets.
2233 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2234 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2235 @end deffn
2236
2237 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_register_access_error (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2238 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2239 packets report errors or not.
2240 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2241 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2242 @end deffn
2243
2244 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2245 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2246 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2247 @end deffn
2248
2249 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2250 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2251
2252 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2253 @end deffn
2254
2255 @anchor{eventpolling}
2256 @section Event Polling
2257
2258 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2259 where significant events can happen at any time.
2260 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2261 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2262 or to GDB.
2263
2264 Examples of such events include:
2265
2266 @itemize
2267 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2268 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2269 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2270 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2271 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2272 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2273 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2274 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2275 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2276 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2277 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2278 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2279 @end itemize
2280
2281 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2282 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2283 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2284 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2285 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2286
2287 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2288 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2289 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2290 to the various active targets.
2291 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2292 which is normally done in the background.
2293
2294 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2295 Poll the current target for its current state.
2296 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2297 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2298 specific information about the current state is printed.
2299 An optional parameter
2300 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2301
2302 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2303 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2304 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2305 @example
2306 > poll
2307 background polling: on
2308 target state: halted
2309 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2310 current mode: Supervisor
2311 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2312 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2313 >
2314 @end example
2315 @end deffn
2316
2317 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2318 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2319 @cindex config file, interface
2320 @cindex interface config file
2321
2322 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2323 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2324 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2325
2326 @quotation Note
2327 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2328 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2329 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2330 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2331 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2332 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2333 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2334 @end quotation
2335
2336 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2337 through commands in an interface configuration
2338 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2339 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2340
2341 @example
2342 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2343 @end example
2344
2345 These commands tell
2346 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2347 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2348
2349 @example
2350 # jlink interface
2351 adapter driver jlink
2352 @end example
2353
2354 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2355
2356
2357 @section Adapter Configuration
2358
2359 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2360 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2361 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2362
2363 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2364 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2365 target.
2366 @end deffn
2367
2368 @deffn Command {adapter list}
2369 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2370 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2371 @end deffn
2372 @deffn Command {adapter transports} transport_name+
2373 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2374 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2375 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2376 the hardware can support.
2377 @end deffn
2378
2379
2380
2381 @deffn Command {adapter name}
2382 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2383 @end deffn
2384
2385 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2386 @deffn Command {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2387 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2388 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2389 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2390 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2391 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2392
2393 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2394 @end deffn
2395
2396 @section Interface Drivers
2397
2398 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2399 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2400 available at run time.
2401
2402 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2403 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2404 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2405 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2406
2407 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2408 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2409 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2410 @end deffn
2411
2412 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2413 Displays status of RTCK option.
2414 Optionally sets that option first.
2415 @end deffn
2416 @end deffn
2417
2418 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2419 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2420 This has one driver-specific command:
2421
2422 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2423 Logs some status
2424 @end deffn
2425 @end deffn
2426
2427 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2428 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2429 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2430 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2431 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2432 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2433 @end deffn
2434
2435 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2436 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
2437
2438 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2439 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2440 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2441 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2442 @example
2443 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2444 @end example
2445 @end deffn
2446
2447 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2448 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2449 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2450 @end deffn
2451
2452 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2453 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2454 @end deffn
2455 @end deffn
2456
2457 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2458 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2459 @end deffn
2460
2461 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2462 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2463 @end deffn
2464
2465 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2466 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2467 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2468
2469 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2470 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi or D2XX.
2471
2472 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2473 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2474
2475 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2476 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2477 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2478 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2479 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2480 @command{ftdi_get_signal} command.
2481
2482 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2483 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2484 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2485 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2486 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2487
2488 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2489 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2490 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2491 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2492
2493 @itemize @minus
2494 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2495 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2496 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2497 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2498 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2499 switching data and direction as necessary
2500 @end itemize
2501
2502 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2503 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2504
2505 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2506 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2507 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2508 @example
2509 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2510 @end example
2511 @end deffn
2512
2513 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2514 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2515 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2516 during device selection.
2517 @end deffn
2518
2519 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2520 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2521 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2522 is connected to the host.
2523 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2524 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2525 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2526 @end deffn
2527
2528 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_location} <bus>-<port>[.<port>]...
2529 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
2530 Use the command @ref{adapter_usb_location,,adapter usb location} instead.}
2531
2532 Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2533 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2534 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2535 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2536 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t}.
2537
2538 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2539 @end deffn
2540
2541 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2542 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2543 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2544 @end deffn
2545
2546 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2547 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2548 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2549 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2550 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2551 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2552 and initially asserted reset signals.
2553 @end deffn
2554
2555 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2556 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2557 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2558 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2559 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2560 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2561 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2562 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2563 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2564 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2565 with the method @command{ftdi_get_signal}.
2566
2567 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2568 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2569 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2570 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2571 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2572 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2573
2574 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2575 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2576 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2577 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2578 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2579 are always driven by the FTDI.
2580
2581 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2582 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2583 @var{name}.
2584 @end deffn
2585
2586 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2587 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2588 @itemize @minus
2589 @item @option{0}, drive low
2590 @item @option{1}, drive high
2591 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2592 @end itemize
2593 @end deffn
2594
2595 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_get_signal} name
2596 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2597 @end deffn
2598
2599 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2600 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2601
2602 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2603 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2604 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2605 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2606 @itemize @minus
2607 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2608 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2609 @end itemize
2610 @end deffn
2611
2612 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2613 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2614
2615 @end deffn
2616
2617 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2618 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2619 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2620 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2621
2622 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2623 @itemize @minus
2624 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2625 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2626 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2627 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2628 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2629 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2630 @end itemize
2631
2632 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2633 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2634 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2635 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2636 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2637 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2638 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2639 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2640
2641 FT232R
2642 @itemize @minus
2643 @item bit 7 - RI
2644 @item bit 6 - DCD
2645 @item bit 5 - DSR
2646 @item bit 4 - DTR
2647 @item bit 3 - CTS
2648 @item bit 2 - RTS
2649 @item bit 1 - RXD
2650 @item bit 0 - TXD
2651 @end itemize
2652
2653 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2654 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2655
2656 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2657 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2658 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2659 @end deffn
2660
2661 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_serial_desc} @var{serial}
2662 Specifies the @var{serial} of the adapter to use, in case the
2663 vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter is connected to
2664 the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2665 @end deffn
2666
2667 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2668 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2669 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2670 @end deffn
2671
2672 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tck_num} @var{tck}
2673 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2674 @end deffn
2675
2676 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tms_num} @var{tms}
2677 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2678 @end deffn
2679
2680 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2681 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2682 @end deffn
2683
2684 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2685 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2686 @end deffn
2687
2688 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_trst_num} @var{trst}
2689 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2690 @end deffn
2691
2692 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_srst_num} @var{srst}
2693 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2694 @end deffn
2695
2696 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_restore_serial} @var{word}
2697 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2698 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2699 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2700 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2701 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2702 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2703 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2704 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2705 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2706 @end deffn
2707
2708 @end deffn
2709
2710 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2711 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2712 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2713 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2714
2715 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2716 processors which are being simulated.
2717
2718 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2719 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2720 sockets instead of TCP.
2721 @end deffn
2722
2723 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2724 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2725 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2726 @end deffn
2727
2728 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2729 something like:
2730
2731 @example
2732 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2733 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2734 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2735 @end example
2736
2737 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2738 named mysocket:
2739
2740 @example
2741 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2742 remote_bitbang_port 0
2743 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2744 @end example
2745 @end deffn
2746
2747 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2748 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2749 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2750 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2751
2752 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2753 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2754 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2755 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2756 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2757 @end deffn
2758
2759 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2760 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2761 default values are used.
2762 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2763 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2764 @example
2765 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2766 @end example
2767 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2768 @example
2769 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2770 @end example
2771 @end deffn
2772
2773 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2774 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2775 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2776 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2777 target board.
2778
2779 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2780 @example
2781 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2782 reset_config srst_only
2783 @end example
2784 @end deffn
2785
2786 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2787 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2788 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2789 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2790 @end deffn
2791
2792 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2793 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2794 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2795 @end deffn
2796
2797 @end deffn
2798
2799 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2800 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2801 This has one driver-specific command:
2802
2803 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2804 Display either the address of the I/O port
2805 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2806 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2807 This is a write-once setting.
2808 @end deffn
2809 @end deffn
2810
2811 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2812 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2813 transports.
2814
2815 @quotation Compatibility Note
2816 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2817 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2818 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2819 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2820 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2821 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2822 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2823 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2824 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2825 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2826 @end quotation
2827
2828 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2829 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2830 states.
2831 @end deffn
2832 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2833 Display free device internal memory.
2834 @end deffn
2835 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2836 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2837 command version.
2838 @end deffn
2839 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2840 Display the device configuration.
2841 @end deffn
2842 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2843 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2844 power state.
2845 @end deffn
2846 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2847 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2848 @end deffn
2849 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2850 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2851 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2852 IP configuration.
2853 @end deffn
2854 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2855 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2856 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2857 @end deffn
2858 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2859 Reset the current configuration.
2860 @end deffn
2861 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2862 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2863 @end deffn
2864 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write <channel> <data>}
2865 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2866 pairs.
2867
2868 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2869 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2870 @example
2871 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2872 @end example
2873 @end deffn
2874 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read <channel> <length>}
2875 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2876 pairs.
2877
2878 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2879 @example
2880 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2881 77a90000
2882 @end example
2883 @end deffn
2884 @deffn {Config} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2885 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2886 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2887 selection via USB address is deprecated and the serial number should be used
2888 instead.
2889
2890 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2891 @end deffn
2892 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2893 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2894 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2895
2896 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2897 @end deffn
2898 @end deffn
2899
2900 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2901 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2902 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2903 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2904 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2905 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2906 configuration script.
2907
2908 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2909 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2910 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2911 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2912 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2913
2914 Known limitations:
2915 @itemize @bullet
2916 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2917 and 2.7 MHz.
2918 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2919 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2920 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2921 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2922 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2923 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2924 communications with the target.
2925 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2926 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2927 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2928 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2929 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2930 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2931 @end itemize
2932
2933 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2934 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2935 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2936 @end deffn
2937
2938 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
2939 Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
2940 device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
2941 @end deffn
2942
2943 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2944 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2945 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2946 target as a side-effect.
2947 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2948 @end deffn
2949
2950 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2951 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2952 version, and target voltage.
2953 @end deffn
2954 @end deffn
2955
2956 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2957 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2958 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2959 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2960 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2961
2962 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2963 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2964 This is a write-once setting.
2965 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2966
2967 @itemize @minus
2968 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2969 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2970 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2971 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2972 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2973 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2974 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2975 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2976 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2977 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2978 some versions of
2979 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2980 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2981 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2982 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2983 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2984 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2985 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2986 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2987 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2988 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2989 @end itemize
2990 @end deffn
2991
2992 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2993 Display either the address of the I/O port
2994 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2995 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2996 This is a write-once setting.
2997
2998 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2999 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
3000 you may encounter a problem.
3001 @end deffn
3002
3003 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
3004 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
3005 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
3006 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
3007 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
3008 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
3009
3010 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
3011 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
3012 @quotation Tip
3013 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
3014 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
3015 @example
3016 > parport_toggling_time 1000
3017 > adapter speed 500
3018 @end example
3019 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
3020 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
3021 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
3022 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
3023 large set of samples.
3024 Update the setting to match your measurement:
3025 @example
3026 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
3027 @end example
3028 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
3029 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3030
3031 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3032 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3033 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3034 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3035 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
3036 be conservative.
3037 @end quotation
3038 @end deffn
3039
3040 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3041 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3042 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3043 @end deffn
3044
3045 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3046 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3047
3048 @example
3049 adapter driver parport
3050 parport_port 0x278
3051 parport_cable wiggler
3052 @end example
3053 @end deffn
3054
3055 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3056 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3057 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
3058 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
3059 @end deffn
3060 @end deffn
3061
3062 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3063 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3064 @end deffn
3065
3066 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3067 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3068 @end deffn
3069
3070 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3071 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3072
3073 @quotation Note
3074 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3075 which are not currently documented here.
3076 @end quotation
3077 @end deffn
3078
3079 @anchor{hla_interface}
3080 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3081 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3082 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3083 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3084
3085 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK and TI ICDI.
3086 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3087 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3088 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3089 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3090
3091 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3092 Currently Not Supported.
3093 @end deffn
3094
3095 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
3096 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3097 @end deffn
3098
3099 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi})
3100 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3101 @end deffn
3102
3103 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3104 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3105 @end deffn
3106
3107 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3108 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3109 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3110 @end deffn
3111 @end deffn
3112
3113 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3114 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3115 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3116 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3117 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3118
3119 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3120 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3121 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3122 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3123
3124 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3125 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3126
3127 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link serial} serial
3128 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3129 @end deffn
3130
3131 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3132 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3133 @end deffn
3134 @end deffn
3135
3136 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3137 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3138 @end deffn
3139
3140 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3141 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3142 @end deffn
3143
3144 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3145 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3146 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3147 fabric based JTAG devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3148 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3149
3150 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3151
3152 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc_config} device
3153 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3154
3155 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3156 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3157
3158 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3159
3160 @end deffn
3161 @end deffn
3162
3163 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
3164 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
3165 @end deffn
3166
3167 @quotation Note
3168 This defines some driver-specific commands,
3169 which are not currently documented here.
3170 @end quotation
3171
3172 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
3173 Turn power switch to target on/off.
3174 No arguments: print status.
3175 @end deffn
3176
3177 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3178 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3179 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3180
3181 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3182 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3183 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3184 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3185 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3186 configuration on exit.
3187
3188 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3189 pinout.
3190
3191 @end deffn
3192
3193 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3194 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3195 of the one which is most popular.
3196
3197 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3198
3199 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3200 pinout.
3201
3202 @end deffn
3203
3204
3205 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3206 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3207 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3208
3209 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_variant} variant
3210 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3211 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3212
3213 @itemize @minus
3214 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3215 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3216 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3217 @end itemize
3218 @end deffn
3219
3220 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_device_desc} string
3221 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3222 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3223 @end deffn
3224 @end deffn
3225
3226 @section Transport Configuration
3227 @cindex Transport
3228 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3229 and the debug adapter you are using,
3230 several transports may be available to
3231 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3232 @deffn Command {transport list}
3233 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3234 version of OpenOCD.
3235 @end deffn
3236
3237 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3238 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3239
3240 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3241 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3242 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3243 adapter's driver).
3244
3245 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3246 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3247 supported by the debug adapter.
3248
3249 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3250 transport, if any.
3251 @end deffn
3252
3253 @subsection JTAG Transport
3254 @cindex JTAG
3255 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3256 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3257 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3258 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3259 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3260 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3261
3262 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3263 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3264 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3265 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3266 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3267
3268 @subsection SWD Transport
3269 @cindex SWD
3270 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3271 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3272 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3273 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3274 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3275 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3276 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3277
3278 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3279 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3280 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3281 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3282 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3283
3284 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3285 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3286 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3287 expected to change.
3288 @end deffn
3289 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3290 Updates TRN (turnaround delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3291 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3292 No parameters: displays current settings.
3293 @end deffn
3294
3295 @subsection SPI Transport
3296 @cindex SPI
3297 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3298 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3299 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3300 solution for flash programming.
3301
3302 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3303 @section JTAG Speed
3304 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3305 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3306 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3307 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3308 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3309 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3310 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3311 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3312 power management software that may be active.
3313
3314 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3315 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3316 target event handler.
3317 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3318 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3319 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3320 sets up those clocks).
3321 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3322 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3323 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3324 in the target config file.
3325 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3326 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3327 config file instead.
3328 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3329 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3330 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3331
3332 @example
3333 jtag_rclk 3000
3334 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3335 @end example
3336
3337 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3338 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3339 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3340 may not be the fastest solution.
3341
3342 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3343 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3344 which support adaptive clocking.
3345
3346 @deffn {Command} adapter speed max_speed_kHz
3347 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3348 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3349 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3350 than the speed specified.
3351
3352 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3353 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3354 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3355 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3356
3357 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3358 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3359 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3360 JTAG clocking after setup.
3361 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3362 If the interface device can not
3363 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3364 @end deffn
3365
3366 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3367 @cindex adaptive clocking
3368 @cindex RTCK
3369 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3370 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3371 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3372 @example
3373 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3374 jtag_rclk 3000
3375 @end example
3376 @end defun
3377
3378 @node Reset Configuration
3379 @chapter Reset Configuration
3380 @cindex Reset Configuration
3381
3382 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3383 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3384 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3385 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3386 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3387 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3388 Please see the various board files for examples.
3389
3390 @quotation Note
3391 To maintainers and integrators:
3392 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3393 Normally the board configuration file
3394 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3395 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3396
3397 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3398 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3399 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3400 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3401 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3402 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3403 @end quotation
3404
3405 @section Types of Reset
3406
3407 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3408 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3409 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3410
3411 @itemize @bullet
3412 @item
3413 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3414 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3415 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3416 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3417 @item
3418 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3419 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3420 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3421 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3422 @item
3423 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3424 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3425 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3426 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3427 @item
3428 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3429 several other types of reset.
3430 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3431 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3432 There may be individual module resets.
3433 @end itemize
3434
3435 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3436 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3437 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3438 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3439 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3440 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3441 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3442 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3443 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3444
3445 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3446 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3447
3448 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3449 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3450 common issues are:
3451
3452 @itemize @bullet
3453
3454 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3455 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3456 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3457 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3458 when either of those signals is not connected.
3459 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3460 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3461 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3462 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3463
3464 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3465 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3466 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3467 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3468
3469 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3470 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3471 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3472 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3473 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3474 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3475 hardware debouncing.
3476 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3477 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3478
3479 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3480 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3481 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3482 to use push/pull output drivers.
3483 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3484 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3485 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3486 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3487
3488 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3489 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3490 issues (not limited to errata).
3491 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3492 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3493 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3494 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3495 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3496 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3497 @end itemize
3498
3499 There can also be other issues.
3500 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3501 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3502 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3503 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3504 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3505 Agreement (NDA).
3506
3507 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3508 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3509 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3510
3511 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3512 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3513
3514 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3515
3516 @deffn {Command} adapter srst pulse_width milliseconds
3517 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3518 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3519 allowing it to be deasserted.
3520 @end deffn
3521
3522 @deffn {Command} adapter srst delay milliseconds
3523 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3524 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3525 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3526 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3527 @end deffn
3528
3529 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3530 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3531 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3532 allowing it to be deasserted.
3533 @end deffn
3534
3535 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3536 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3537 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3538 @end deffn
3539
3540 @anchor{reset_config}
3541 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3542 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3543 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3544 configuration scripts.
3545
3546 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3547 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3548 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3549 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3550 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3551 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3552 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3553 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3554
3555 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3556 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3557 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3558 -- may be specified at a time.
3559 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3560 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3561 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3562 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3563 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3564
3565 @itemize
3566 @item
3567 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3568 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3569 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3570 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3571 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3572
3573 @quotation Tip
3574 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3575 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3576 @end quotation
3577
3578 @item
3579 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3580 signal implementations.
3581 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3582 indicating everything behaves normally.
3583 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3584 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3585 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3586 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3587 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3588 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3589 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3590
3591 @item
3592 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3593 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3594 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3595 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3596 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3597 while SRST is asserted.
3598 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3599 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3600
3601 @item
3602 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3603 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3604 is required to use this option.
3605 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3606 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3607 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3608 be asserted before any target connection.
3609 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3610 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3611 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3612 @end itemize
3613
3614 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3615 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3616 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3617 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3618 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3619
3620 @itemize
3621 @item
3622 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3623 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3624 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3625 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3626
3627 @item
3628 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3629 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3630 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3631 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3632 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3633 @end itemize
3634 @end deffn
3635
3636 @section Custom Reset Handling
3637 @cindex events
3638
3639 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3640 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3641 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3642 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3643 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3644 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3645
3646 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3647 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3648 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3649 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3650 want to reset everything at once.
3651
3652 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3653 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3654 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3655 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3656 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3657 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3658 needs special attention.
3659
3660 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
3661 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
3662 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3663 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3664 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3665 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3666 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3667 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3668 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3669
3670 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3671 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3672 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3673 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3674 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3675
3676 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3677 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3678 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3679 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3680 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3681 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3682 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3683 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3684 or potentially some other value.
3685
3686 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3687 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3688 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
3689 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3690 (or their associated targets)
3691 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3692
3693 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3694 they return.
3695 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3696 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3697 @end deffn
3698
3699 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3700 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3701 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3702 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3703 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3704 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3705 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3706 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3707 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3708 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3709 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3710 @end deffn
3711
3712 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3713 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3714 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3715 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3716 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3717 @end deffn
3718
3719
3720 @node TAP Declaration
3721 @chapter TAP Declaration
3722 @cindex TAP declaration
3723 @cindex TAP configuration
3724
3725 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3726 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3727
3728 @itemize @bullet
3729 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3730 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3731 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3732 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3733 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3734 start running that code.
3735 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3736 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3737 and missing connections.
3738 @end itemize
3739
3740 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3741 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3742 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3743 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3744 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3745
3746 @section Scan Chains
3747 @cindex scan chain
3748
3749 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3750 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3751 They also need to be added to
3752 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3753 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3754 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3755 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3756 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3757 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3758 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3759 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3760
3761 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3762 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3763 command, presented in the next chapter.
3764 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3765 debugging targets.)
3766 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3767
3768 @verbatim
3769 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3770 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3771 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3772 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3773 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3774 @end verbatim
3775
3776 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3777 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3778 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3779 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3780 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3781 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3782 until they are told to do so.
3783
3784 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3785 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3786 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3787 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3788
3789 @example
3790 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3791 @end example
3792
3793 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3794 by a given chip.
3795 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3796 and so forth.
3797 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3798 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3799 both inside a single chip and between them.
3800 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3801
3802 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
3803 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3804 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3805 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3806 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3807 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3808 includes commands something like this:
3809
3810 @example
3811 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3812 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3813 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3814 @end example
3815
3816 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3817 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3818 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3819
3820 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3821 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3822 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3823 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3824 @example
3825 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3826 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3827 @}
3828 @end example
3829 @end deffn
3830
3831 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3832 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3833 and their status.
3834 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3835 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3836 but systems with a JTAG router can
3837 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3838 @end deffn
3839
3840 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3841 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3842
3843 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3844 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3845
3846 @section TAP Names
3847 @cindex dotted name
3848
3849 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3850 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3851 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3852 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3853 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3854 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3855 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3856 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3857
3858 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3859 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3860 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3861
3862 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3863
3864 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3865 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3866 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3867 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3868
3869 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3870 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3871 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3872 overridable.
3873
3874 @cindex TAP naming convention
3875 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3876 and should follow this convention:
3877
3878 @itemize @bullet
3879 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3880 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3881 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3882 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3883 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3884 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3885 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3886 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3887 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3888 with a single TAP;
3889 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3890 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3891 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3892 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3893 @end itemize
3894
3895 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3896
3897 @itemize @bullet
3898 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3899 @*The length in bits of the
3900 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3901 @end itemize
3902
3903 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3904
3905 @itemize @bullet
3906 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3907 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3908 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3909 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3910 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3911 (the TAP is linked in).
3912 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3913 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3914 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3915 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3916 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3917 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3918 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3919 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3920 values that were found but not included in the list.
3921
3922 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3923 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3924 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3925 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3926 hardware to find these values.
3927 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3928 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3929 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3930 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3931 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3932 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3933 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3934 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3935 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3936 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3937 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3938 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3939 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3940 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3941 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
3942 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
3943 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
3944 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
3945 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
3946 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
3947 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
3948 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
3949 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
3950 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
3951 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
3952 @end itemize
3953 @end deffn
3954
3955 @section Other TAP commands
3956
3957 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
3958 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
3959 @end deffn
3960
3961 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
3962 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
3963 At this writing this TAP attribute
3964 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
3965 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
3966 mechanism for debugger targets.)
3967 See the next section for information about the available events.
3968
3969 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
3970 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
3971 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
3972 @end deffn
3973
3974 @section TAP Events
3975 @cindex events
3976 @cindex TAP events
3977
3978 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
3979 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
3980 The other applies to debugger targets,
3981 which are associated with certain TAPs.
3982
3983 The TAP events currently defined are:
3984
3985 @itemize @bullet
3986 @item @b{post-reset}
3987 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
3988 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
3989 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
3990 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
3991 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
3992
3993 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
3994 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
3995 of any particular target.
3996 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
3997 @item @b{setup}
3998 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
3999 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4000 @item @b{tap-disable}
4001 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4002 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4003 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4004 @item @b{tap-enable}
4005 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4006 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4007 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4008 @end itemize
4009
4010 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4011 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4012 contents to be accurate), you might:
4013
4014 @example
4015 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4016 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4017 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4018 @}
4019 @end example
4020
4021
4022 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4023 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4024 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4025 @cindex jrc
4026
4027 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4028 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4029 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4030 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4031 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4032
4033 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4034 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4035 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4036 be visible.
4037 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4038 ignores, such as:
4039
4040 @itemize
4041 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4042 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4043 TAPs receive new instructions.
4044 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4045 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4046 @end itemize
4047
4048 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4049 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4050 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4051 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4052
4053 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4054 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4055
4056 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4057 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4058 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4059 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4060 should define TAP event handlers using
4061 code that looks something like this:
4062
4063 @example
4064 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4065 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4066 @}
4067 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4068 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4069 @}
4070 @end example
4071
4072 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4073
4074 @example
4075 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4076 @end example
4077
4078 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4079 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4080 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4081 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4082
4083 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4084 If necessary, disables the tap
4085 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4086 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4087 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4088 and "0" if it is disabled.
4089 @end deffn
4090
4091 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4092 If necessary, enables the tap
4093 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4094 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4095 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4096 and "0" if it is disabled.
4097 @end deffn
4098
4099 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4100 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4101 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4102 and "0" if it is disabled.
4103
4104 @quotation Note
4105 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4106 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4107 @end quotation
4108 @end deffn
4109
4110 @anchor{autoprobing}
4111 @section Autoprobing
4112 @cindex autoprobe
4113 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4114
4115 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4116 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4117 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4118 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4119
4120 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4121 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4122 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4123 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4124 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4125 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4126 right when they come out of reset).
4127
4128 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4129
4130 @example
4131 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4132 reset_config trst_and_srst
4133 jtag_rclk 8
4134 @end example
4135
4136 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4137 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4138
4139 @enumerate
4140 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4141 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4142 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4143 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4144 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4145 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4146 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4147 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4148 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4149 that is discovered.
4150 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4151 register, it will report it.
4152 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4153 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4154 @end enumerate
4155
4156 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4157 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4158 that's a bit more complex:
4159
4160 @example
4161 clock speed 8 kHz
4162 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4163 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4164 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4165 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4166 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4167 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4168 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4169 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4170 @end example
4171
4172 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4173 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4174 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4175 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4176 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4177 and so forth.
4178
4179 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4180 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4181 @cindex DAP declaration
4182
4183 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4184 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4185 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4186 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4187 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4188
4189 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4190
4191 @deffn Command {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4192 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4193 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4194 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4195 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4196
4197 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4198
4199 @itemize @bullet
4200 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4201 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4202 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4203 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4204 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4205 @end itemize
4206 @end deffn
4207
4208 @deffn Command {dap names}
4209 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4210 for TCL scripting.
4211 @end deffn
4212
4213 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
4214 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4215 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4216 @end deffn
4217
4218 @deffn Command {dap init}
4219 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4220 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4221 initialization, too.
4222 @end deffn
4223
4224 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4225
4226 @deffn Command {$dap_name info} [num]
4227 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4228 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4229 @end deffn
4230
4231 @deffn Command {$dap_name apid} [num]
4232 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4233 @end deffn
4234
4235 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4236 @deffn Command {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4237 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4238 or set a new value @var{value}.
4239 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4240 @end deffn
4241
4242 @deffn Command {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4243 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4244 @end deffn
4245
4246 @deffn Command {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4247 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4248 value @var{value}.
4249
4250 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4251 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4252 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4253
4254 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4255 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4256 @end deffn
4257
4258 @deffn Command {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4259 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4260 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4261 @end deffn
4262
4263 @deffn Command {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4264 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4265 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4266 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4267 @end deffn
4268
4269 @deffn Command {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4270 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4271
4272 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4273 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4274 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4275 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4276 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4277 for details.
4278
4279 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4280 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4281 the pattern:
4282 @example
4283 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4284 @end example
4285
4286 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4287 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4288 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4289 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4290 @example
4291 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4292 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4293 @end example
4294
4295 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4296 @example
4297 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4298 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4299 @end example
4300
4301 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4302 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4303
4304 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4305 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4306 example with a proper dap name:
4307 @example
4308 xxx.dap apcsw default
4309 @end example
4310 @end deffn
4311
4312 @deffn Command {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4313 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4314 Disabled by default
4315 @end deffn
4316
4317
4318 @node CPU Configuration
4319 @chapter CPU Configuration
4320 @cindex GDB target
4321
4322 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4323 You can also access these targets without GDB
4324 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4325 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4326 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4327 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4328
4329 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4330 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4331
4332 @section Target List
4333 @cindex target, current
4334 @cindex target, list
4335
4336 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4337 where each member has a name.
4338 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4339 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4340 (plural!) command.
4341 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4342 look like with more than one:
4343 @verbatim
4344 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4345 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4346 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4347 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4348 @end verbatim
4349
4350 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4351 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4352 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4353 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4354 space seen by that current target.
4355 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4356 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4357 are examples; and there are many more.
4358
4359 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4360
4361 @deffn Command {target current}
4362 Returns the name of the current target.
4363 @end deffn
4364
4365 @deffn Command {target names}
4366 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4367 @example
4368 foreach t [target names] @{
4369 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4370 @}
4371 @end example
4372 @end deffn
4373
4374 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4375 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4376
4377 @deffn Command targets [name]
4378 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4379 command names are singular.}
4380
4381 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4382 targets in a user friendly form.
4383
4384 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4385 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4386 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4387 @end deffn
4388
4389 @section Target CPU Types
4390 @cindex target type
4391 @cindex CPU type
4392
4393 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4394 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4395 when calling @command{target create}.
4396 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4397 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4398 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4399 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4400 what core-specific commands may be available
4401 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4402 and more.
4403
4404 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4405 since there's a command to list them.
4406
4407 @anchor{targettypes}
4408 @deffn Command {target types}
4409 Lists all supported target types.
4410 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4411
4412 @itemize @bullet
4413 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4414 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4415 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4416 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4417 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4418 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4419 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4420 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4421 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4422 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4423 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4424 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4425 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4426 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4427 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4428 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4429 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4430 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4431 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4432 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4433 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4434 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4435 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4436 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4437 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4438 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4439 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4440 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of support for new CPUs.
4441 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4442 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4443 @item @code{nds32_v2} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v2 core.
4444 @item @code{nds32_v3} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3 core.
4445 @item @code{nds32_v3m} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3m core.
4446 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4447 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4448 @itemize @minus
4449 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4450 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4451 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4452 @end itemize
4453 And two debug interfaces cores:
4454 @itemize @minus
4455 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4456 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4457 @end itemize
4458 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4459 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4460 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4461 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4462 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4463 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4464 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4465 @end itemize
4466 @end deffn
4467
4468 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4469 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4470 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4471 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4472 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4473 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4474 reflect design generations;
4475 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4476 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4477
4478 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4479 @section Target Configuration
4480
4481 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4482 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4483 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4484 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4485 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4486
4487 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4488 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4489 optional parts.
4490 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4491 command, created as part of target creation.
4492
4493 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4494 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4495 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4496 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4497 to be much more board-specific.
4498 The key steps you use might look something like this
4499
4500 @example
4501 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4502 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4503 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4504 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4505 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4506 @end example
4507
4508 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4509 on-chip SRAM.
4510 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4511 writes to target memory;
4512 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4513 GDB memory checksumming;
4514 and more.
4515
4516 @quotation Warning
4517 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4518 inaccessible when application code
4519 (such as an operating system)
4520 enables or disables the MMU.
4521 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4522 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4523 easy access to other addresses needed.
4524 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4525 @end quotation
4526
4527 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4528 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4529 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4530 controllers.
4531 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4532 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4533 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4534
4535 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4536 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4537 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4538 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4539 purposes including additional configuration.
4540
4541 @itemize @bullet
4542 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4543 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4544 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4545 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4546
4547 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4548 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4549 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4550 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4551 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4552 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4553 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4554
4555 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4556 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4557 @end itemize
4558 @end deffn
4559
4560 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4561 The options accepted by this command may also be
4562 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4563 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4564 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4565
4566 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4567 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4568 and changing its endianness.
4569
4570 @itemize @bullet
4571
4572 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4573 used to access this target.
4574
4575 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4576 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4577 create and manage DAP instances.
4578
4579 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4580 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4581
4582 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4583 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4584 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4585 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4586 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4587 same event name assigns only one handler.
4588
4589 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4590 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4591
4592 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4593 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4594 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4595 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4596 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4597 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4598 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4599
4600 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4601 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4602 or virtual address is being used.
4603
4604 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4605 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4606
4607 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4608 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4609 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4610 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4611 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4612
4613 @anchor{rtostype}
4614 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4615 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4616 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4617 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx}
4618 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4619
4620 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4621 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4622 access the target for debugging.
4623
4624 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4625 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4626 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4627 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4628
4629 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4630 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4631 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4632 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4633 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4634
4635 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4636 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4637 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4638 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4639 command @command{gdb_port}.
4640 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4641 @end itemize
4642 @end deffn
4643
4644 @section Other $target_name Commands
4645 @cindex object command
4646
4647 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4648 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4649
4650 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4651 Once a button is created a button
4652 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4653 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4654 configure it like this:
4655
4656 @example
4657 # Create
4658 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4659 # Modify
4660 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4661 # Query
4662 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4663 # Report
4664 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4665 @end example
4666
4667 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4668 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4669
4670 @example
4671 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4672 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4673 @end example
4674
4675 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4676
4677 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4678 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4679 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4680 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4681 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4682 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4683 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4684 They are not otherwise documented here.
4685 @end deffn
4686
4687 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4688 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4689 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4690 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4691 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4692 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4693 the target side uses raw memory.
4694
4695 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4696 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4697 The script orientation comes from working with data
4698 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4699 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4700 and neither store nor return those values.
4701
4702 @itemize
4703 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4704 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4705 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4706 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4707 @end itemize
4708 @end deffn
4709
4710 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4711 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4712 @command{$target_name configure}
4713 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4714 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4715 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4716 There are a few special cases:
4717
4718 @itemize @bullet
4719 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4720 event named @var{event_name}.
4721 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4722 two parameters.
4723 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4724 This is a special case because this is set using
4725 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4726 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4727 @end itemize
4728
4729 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4730 all the targets you might use something like this:
4731
4732 @example
4733 foreach name [target names] @{
4734 set y [$name cget -endian]
4735 set z [$name cget -type]
4736 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4737 $x $name $y $z]
4738 @}
4739 @end example
4740 @end deffn
4741
4742 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4743 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4744 Displays the current target state:
4745 @code{debug-running},
4746 @code{halted},
4747 @code{reset},
4748 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4749 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4750 @end deffn
4751
4752 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4753 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4754 currently associated with this target.
4755 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4756 @end deffn
4757
4758 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4759 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4760 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4761 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4762 @end deffn
4763
4764 @deffn Command {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
4765 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
4766 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
4767 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
4768 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4769 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
4770 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4771 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4772 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4773 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4774 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4775 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4776 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4777 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4778 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4779 @end deffn
4780
4781 @deffn Command {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
4782 @deffnx Command {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
4783 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
4784 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
4785 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
4786 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
4787 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4788 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4789 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4790 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4791 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4792 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
4793 @end deffn
4794
4795 @anchor{targetevents}
4796 @section Target Events
4797 @cindex target events
4798 @cindex events
4799 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4800 For example:
4801 @itemize @bullet
4802 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4803 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4804 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4805 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4806 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4807 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4808 to set up system clocks or
4809 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4810 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4811 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4812 @end itemize
4813
4814 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4815 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4816 @command{target create ... -event}.
4817
4818 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4819 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4820 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4821
4822 @example
4823 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
4824 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4825 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4826 @}
4827 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
4828 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
4829 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4830 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4831 @}
4832 @end example
4833
4834 The following target events are defined:
4835
4836 @itemize @bullet
4837 @item @b{debug-halted}
4838 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4839 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4840 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
4841 @item @b{early-halted}
4842 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4843 @item @b{examine-start}
4844 @* Before target examine is called.
4845 @item @b{examine-end}
4846 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4847 @item @b{examine-fail}
4848 @* After target examine fails.
4849 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4850 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
4851 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
4852 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
4853 connect GDB to running target.
4854 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
4855 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
4856 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
4857 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
4858 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
4859 is in RAM or read only memory.
4860 Default is @code{halt}
4861 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4862 @* When GDB disconnects
4863 @item @b{gdb-end}
4864 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4865 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4866 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4867 @code{reset init})
4868 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4869 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4870 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4871 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4872 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4873 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4874 @item @b{gdb-start}
4875 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
4876 @item @b{halted}
4877 @* The target has halted
4878 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4879 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4880 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
4881 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
4882 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4883 @item @b{reset-assert}
4884 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4885 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4886 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4887 it instead of asserting SRST.
4888 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4889 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4890 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4891 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4892 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4893 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4894 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4895 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4896 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4897 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4898 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4899 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4900 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4901 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4902 released on the scan chain.
4903 @item @b{reset-end}
4904 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4905 @item @b{reset-init}
4906 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4907 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4908
4909 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4910 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4911 multiplexing, and so on.
4912 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4913 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4914 @item @b{reset-start}
4915 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
4916 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
4917
4918 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4919 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4920 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4921 @item @b{resume-start}
4922 @* Before any target is resumed
4923 @item @b{resume-end}
4924 @* After all targets have resumed
4925 @item @b{resumed}
4926 @* Target has resumed
4927 @item @b{step-start}
4928 @* Before a target is single-stepped
4929 @item @b{step-end}
4930 @* After single-step has completed
4931 @item @b{trace-config}
4932 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
4933 @end itemize
4934
4935 @node Flash Commands
4936 @chapter Flash Commands
4937
4938 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
4939 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
4940 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
4941 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
4942 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
4943 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
4944 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
4945 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
4946 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
4947
4948 Flash Steps:
4949 @enumerate
4950 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
4951 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
4952 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
4953 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
4954 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
4955 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
4956 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
4957 @item GDB Flashing
4958 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
4959 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
4960 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
4961 @end enumerate
4962
4963 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
4964 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
4965 so that it can't boot.
4966 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
4967 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
4968
4969 @anchor{norconfiguration}
4970 @section Flash Configuration Commands
4971 @cindex flash configuration
4972
4973 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
4974 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
4975 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
4976 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
4977 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
4978 see the driver-specific documentation.
4979
4980 @itemize @bullet
4981 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
4982 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
4983 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
4984 associated with the flash bank being declared.
4985 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
4986 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
4987 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
4988 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
4989 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
4990 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
4991 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
4992 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4993 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
4994 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4995 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
4996 commands to the flash controller.
4997 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
4998 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
4999 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5000 for more information.
5001 @end itemize
5002 @quotation Note
5003 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5004 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5005 @end quotation
5006 @end deffn
5007
5008 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5009 @deffn Command {flash banks}
5010 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5011 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5012 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5013 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5014 @end deffn
5015
5016 @deffn Command {flash list}
5017 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5018 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5019 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5020 @end deffn
5021
5022 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
5023 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5024 depends on the flash type.
5025 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5026 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5027 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5028 but most don't bother.
5029 @end deffn
5030
5031 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5032
5033 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5034 begins.
5035
5036 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5037 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5038 until the programming session is finished.
5039
5040 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5041 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5042
5043 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5044
5045 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5046 @cindex flash erasing
5047 @cindex flash reading
5048 @cindex flash writing
5049 @cindex flash programming
5050 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5051
5052 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5053 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5054 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5055 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5056 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5057
5058 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5059 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5060 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5061 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5062 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5063
5064 @quotation Note
5065 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5066 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5067 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5068 back to a flash bank.
5069 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5070 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5071 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5072 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5073 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5074 @end quotation
5075
5076 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5077 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5078 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5079 disabled first.
5080 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5081 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5082 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5083
5084 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
5085 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5086 up to and including @var{last}.
5087 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5088 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5089 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5090 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5091 @end deffn
5092
5093 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5094 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5095 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5096 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5097 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5098 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5099 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5100 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5101 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5102 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5103 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5104 before erase starts.
5105 @end deffn
5106
5107 @deffn Command {flash filld} address double-word length
5108 @deffnx Command {flash fillw} address word length
5109 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
5110 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
5111 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5112 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5113 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5114 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5115 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5116 before issuing this command.
5117 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5118 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5119 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5120 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5121 @end deffn
5122 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5123
5124 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5125 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5126 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5127 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5128 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5129 @end deffn
5130
5131 @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5132 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5133 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5134 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5135 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5136 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5137 @end deffn
5138
5139 @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5140 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5141 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5142 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5143 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5144 @end deffn
5145
5146 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5147 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5148 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5149 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5150 to the base address for each section in the image.
5151 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5152 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5153 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5154 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5155 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5156 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5157 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5158 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5159 each image section.
5160
5161 @quotation Warning
5162 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5163 data you want to preserve.
5164 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5165 sections might be erased with no notice.
5166 @itemize
5167 @item
5168 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5169 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5170 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5171 @item
5172 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5173 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5174 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5175 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5176 @end itemize
5177 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5178 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5179 @end quotation
5180
5181 @end deffn
5182
5183 @section Other Flash commands
5184 @cindex flash protection
5185
5186 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
5187 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5188 and display that status.
5189 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5190 @end deffn
5191
5192 @deffn Command {flash info} num [sectors]
5193 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5194 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5195
5196 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5197 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5198 and possibly stale information.
5199 @end deffn
5200
5201 @anchor{flashprotect}
5202 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5203 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5204 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5205 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5206 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5207 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5208 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5209 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5210 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5211 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5212 @end deffn
5213
5214 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
5215 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5216 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5217 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5218 @end deffn
5219
5220 @anchor{program}
5221 @deffn Command {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5222 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5223 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5224 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5225 @end deffn
5226
5227 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5228 @section Flash Driver List
5229 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5230 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5231 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5232
5233 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
5234 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5235 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5236
5237 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5238
5239 @itemize
5240 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5241 @end itemize
5242
5243 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5244 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5245 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5246 @example
5247 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5248 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5249 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5250 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5251 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5252 @end example
5253 @end deffn
5254
5255 @subsection External Flash
5256
5257 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
5258 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5259 @cindex CFI
5260 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5261 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5262 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5263 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5264 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5265 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5266 configure a bus and its timings), or
5267 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5268 on the flash chip.
5269 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5270 speed up operation.
5271
5272 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5273
5274 @itemize
5275 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5276 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5277 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5278 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5279 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5280 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5281 @end itemize
5282
5283 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5284 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5285
5286 @example
5287 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5288 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5289 @end example
5290
5291 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5292 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5293 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5294
5295 @example
5296 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5297 @end example
5298
5299 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5300 @end deffn
5301
5302 @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
5303 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5304 @cindex SPI
5305 @cindex jtagspi
5306 @cindex bscan_spi
5307 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5308 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5309 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5310 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5311 accessed through JTAG.
5312
5313 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5314 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5315 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5316 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5317 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5318 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5319
5320 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5321 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5322 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5323 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5324 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5325 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5326 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5327 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5328
5329 @itemize
5330 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5331 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5332 @var{USER1} instruction.
5333 @end itemize
5334
5335 @example
5336 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5337 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5338 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5339 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5340 @end example
5341 @end deffn
5342
5343 @deffn {Flash Driver} xcf
5344 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5345 @cindex xcf
5346 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5347 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5348 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5349 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5350 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5351
5352 @deffn Command {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5353 command accepts additional parameters:
5354 @itemize
5355 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5356 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5357 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5358 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5359 in master mode.
5360 @end itemize
5361 @example
5362 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5363 @end example
5364 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5365 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5366 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5367 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5368 dedicated sector.
5369 @end deffn
5370
5371 @deffn Command {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5372 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5373 button.
5374 @example
5375 xcf configure 0
5376 @end example
5377 @end deffn
5378
5379 Additional driver notes:
5380 @itemize
5381 @item Only single revision supported.
5382 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5383 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5384 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5385 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5386 @end itemize
5387 @end deffn
5388
5389 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
5390 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5391 @cindex SPIFI
5392 @cindex lpcspifi
5393 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5394 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5395 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5396
5397 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5398 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5399 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5400 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5401 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5402
5403 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5404 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5405 are configured by the driver.
5406
5407 @example
5408 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5409 @end example
5410
5411 @end deffn
5412
5413 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
5414 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5415 @cindex SMI
5416 @cindex stmsmi
5417 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5418 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5419 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5420 SPI flash devices.
5421 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5422 flash devices can be connected.
5423
5424 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5425 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5426 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5427 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5428 the flash content.
5429
5430 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5431 to identify the memory bank.
5432 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5433 flash size, are detected automatically.
5434
5435 @example
5436 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5437 @end example
5438
5439 @end deffn
5440
5441 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
5442 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5443 Microcontroller platform.
5444
5445 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5446 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5447
5448 @example
5449 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5450 @end example
5451
5452 @end deffn
5453
5454 @deffn {Flash Driver} ath79
5455 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5456 @cindex ath79
5457 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5458 chip selects.
5459 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5460 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5461 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5462 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5463 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5464 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5465
5466 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5467 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5468 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5469 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5470 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5471 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5472 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5473 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5474 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5475 with the default CS0.
5476 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5477 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5478 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5479
5480 @example
5481 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5482
5483 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different for each,
5484 # otherwise the write_image command is not able to distinguish the
5485 # banks.
5486 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5487 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5488 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5489 @end example
5490
5491 @end deffn
5492
5493 @deffn {Flash Driver} fespi
5494 @cindex Freedom E SPI
5495 @cindex fespi
5496
5497 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
5498
5499 @example
5500 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5501 @end example
5502 @end deffn
5503
5504 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5505
5506 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
5507 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5508 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5509 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5510 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5511 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5512
5513 @example
5514 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5515 @end example
5516 @end deffn
5517
5518 @deffn {Flash Driver} ambiqmicro
5519 @cindex ambiqmicro
5520 @cindex apollo
5521 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5522 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5523 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5524 with the target using SWD.
5525
5526 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5527 the device class of the MCU.
5528 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5529 to set up the flash banks.
5530 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5531 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5532
5533 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5534 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5535 and the second bank starts after the first.
5536
5537 @example
5538 # Flash bank 0
5539 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5540 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5541 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5542 $_TARGETNAME
5543 @end example
5544
5545 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5546 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5547 are available to the user.
5548
5549 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5550
5551 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5552 Erase entire bank.
5553 @end deffn
5554 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5555 Erase device pages.
5556 @end deffn
5557 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5558 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5559 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5560 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5561 the flash.
5562 @end deffn
5563 @end deffn
5564
5565 @anchor{at91samd}
5566 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
5567 @cindex at91samd
5568 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5569 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5570
5571 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
5572
5573 The devices have one flash bank:
5574
5575 @example
5576 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5577 @end example
5578
5579 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
5580 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5581 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5582 processor to be halted.
5583 @end deffn
5584
5585 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
5586 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5587 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5588 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5589 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5590 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5591
5592 @example
5593 at91samd set-security enable
5594 @end example
5595 @end deffn
5596
5597 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
5598 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5599 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5600 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5601 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5602 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
5603 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5604 in order to disable this feature.
5605
5606 @example
5607 at91samd eeprom
5608 at91samd eeprom 1024
5609 @end example
5610 @end deffn
5611
5612 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
5613 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5614 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5615 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5616 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5617 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5618
5619 @example
5620 at91samd bootloader
5621 at91samd bootloader 16384
5622 @end example
5623 @end deffn
5624
5625 @deffn Command {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5626 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5627 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5628 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5629 @end deffn
5630
5631 @deffn Command {at91samd nvmuserrow}
5632 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
5633 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
5634 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
5635 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5636 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
5637 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
5638 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
5639
5640 @example
5641 # Read user row
5642 >at91samd nvmuserrow
5643 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5644 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
5645 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5646 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low byte unchanged
5647 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
5648 @end example
5649 @end deffn
5650
5651 @end deffn
5652
5653 @anchor{at91sam3}
5654 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
5655 @cindex at91sam3
5656 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5657 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5658 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5659 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5660 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5661 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5662 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
5663 chips are confirmed.}
5664
5665 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5666 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5667 the following fixed locations:
5668
5669 @example
5670 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5671 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5672 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5673 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5674 @end example
5675
5676 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5677 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5678 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5679
5680 @itemize
5681 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5682 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5683 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5684 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5685 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5686 @end itemize
5687
5688 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5689
5690 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5691 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5692 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5693 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5694 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5695 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5696 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5697
5698 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5699 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5700 @end deffn
5701
5702 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5703 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5704 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5705 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5706 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5707 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5708 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5709 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5710 @end deffn
5711
5712 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5713 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5714 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5715 @end deffn
5716 @end deffn
5717
5718 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5719 @cindex at91sam4
5720 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5721 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5722 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5723 @end deffn
5724
5725 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
5726 @cindex at91sam4l
5727 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5728 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5729 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5730
5731 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5732 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5733 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5734 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5735 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5736 @end deffn
5737 @end deffn
5738
5739 @anchor{atsame5}
5740 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsame5
5741 @cindex atsame5
5742 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
5743 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
5744 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5745
5746 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
5747 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
5748 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
5749
5750 @example
5751 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5752 @end example
5753
5754 @deffn Command {atsame5 bootloader}
5755 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
5756 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5757 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
5758 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
5759 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5760
5761 @example
5762 atsame5 bootloader
5763 atsame5 bootloader 16384
5764 @end example
5765 @end deffn
5766
5767 @deffn Command {atsame5 chip-erase}
5768 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5769 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5770 processor to be halted.
5771 @end deffn
5772
5773 @deffn Command {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
5774 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5775 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5776 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5777 @end deffn
5778
5779 @deffn Command {atsame5 userpage}
5780 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
5781 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
5782 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
5783 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5784 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
5785 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
5786 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
5787
5788 @example
5789 # Read
5790 >atsame5 userpage
5791 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
5792 # Write
5793 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
5794 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other bits unchanged
5795 # (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192 bytes)
5796 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
5797 @end example
5798 @end deffn
5799
5800 @end deffn
5801
5802 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsamv
5803 @cindex atsamv
5804 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
5805 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
5806 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5807 @end deffn
5808
5809 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
5810 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
5811 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
5812 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
5813 register, and autoconfigures itself.
5814
5815 @example
5816 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5817 @end example
5818
5819 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
5820 provide additional parameters in the following order:
5821
5822 @itemize
5823 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
5824 @item @var{banks}
5825 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
5826 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
5827 @item @var{pages_size}
5828 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
5829 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
5830 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
5831 @end itemize
5832
5833 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
5834 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
5835 will be autoconfigured.
5836 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
5837
5838 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
5839 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
5840 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
5841 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
5842 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
5843
5844 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
5845 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
5846 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
5847 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
5848 are not truly general purpose).
5849 @quotation Note
5850 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
5851 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
5852 @end quotation
5853 @end deffn
5854 @end deffn
5855
5856 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
5857 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
5858 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
5859 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5860 @end deffn
5861
5862 @deffn {Flash Driver} bluenrg-x
5863 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
5864 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
5865 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
5866
5867 @example
5868 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5869 @end example
5870
5871 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
5872 each single sector one by one.
5873
5874 @example
5875 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
5876 @end example
5877
5878 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
5879 @end deffn
5880
5881 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc26xx
5882 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
5883 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
5884 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
5885 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
5886 starts at address 0.
5887
5888 @example
5889 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5890 @end example
5891 @end deffn
5892
5893 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc3220sf
5894 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
5895 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
5896 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
5897 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
5898 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
5899 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
5900 and programming the serial flash.
5901
5902 @example
5903 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5904 @end example
5905 @end deffn
5906
5907 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
5908 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
5909 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
5910 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
5911 autoconfigures itself.
5912 @example
5913 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5914 @end example
5915 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
5916 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
5917 this via the following command:
5918 @example
5919 efm32 debuglock num
5920 @end example
5921 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5922 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
5923 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
5924 supported.}
5925 @end deffn
5926
5927 @deffn {Flash Driver} esirisc
5928 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
5929 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
5930 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
5931 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
5932 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
5933
5934 @example
5935 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
5936 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
5937 @end example
5938
5939 @deffn Command {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
5940 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
5941 @end deffn
5942
5943 @deffn Command {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
5944 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
5945 is an uncommon operation.}
5946 @end deffn
5947 @end deffn
5948
5949 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
5950 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
5951 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
5952 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
5953 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5954 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
5955 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
5956
5957 @example
5958 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5959 @end example
5960 @end deffn
5961
5962 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm4
5963 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
5964 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
5965 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
5966 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5967 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
5968 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
5969 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
5970 characters) ignored.
5971
5972 @example
5973 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
5974 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5975 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
5976 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5977 @end example
5978 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
5979 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
5980 @end deffn
5981
5982 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis
5983 @cindex kinetis
5984 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
5985 from NXP (former Freescale) include
5986 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
5987 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
5988 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5989 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
5990
5991 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
5992 @itemize
5993 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
5994 @end itemize
5995
5996 @example
5997 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5998 @end example
5999
6000 @deffn Command {kinetis create_banks}
6001 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6002 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6003 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6004 @end deffn
6005
6006 @deffn Command {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6007 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6008 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6009 set by 'flash protect' command.
6010 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6011 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6012 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6013 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6014 with the rest of a flash image.
6015 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6016 @end deffn
6017
6018 @deffn Command {kinetis fopt} [num]
6019 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6020 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6021 @end deffn
6022
6023 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm check_security}
6024 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6025 and examine-fail event.
6026 @end deffn
6027
6028 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm halt}
6029 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6030 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6031 @end deffn
6032
6033 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6034 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6035 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6036 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6037 command completes.
6038 @end deffn
6039
6040 @deffn Command {kinetis nvm_partition}
6041 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6042 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6043 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6044 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6045
6046 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6047 Program Partition command.
6048
6049 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6050 Reset the device after partition setting.
6051
6052 Show partition size:
6053 @example
6054 kinetis nvm_partition info
6055 @end example
6056
6057 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6058 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6059 @example
6060 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6061 @end example
6062
6063 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6064 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6065 @example
6066 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6067 @end example
6068 @end deffn
6069
6070 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm reset}
6071 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6072 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6073 @end deffn
6074
6075 @deffn Command {kinetis disable_wdog}
6076 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6077 Command disables watchdog timer.
6078 @end deffn
6079 @end deffn
6080
6081 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis_ke
6082 @cindex kinetis_ke
6083 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6084 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6085 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6086 autoconfigures itself.
6087 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6088
6089 @example
6090 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6091 @end example
6092
6093 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6094 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6095 @end deffn
6096
6097 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6098 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6099 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6100 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6101 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6102 @end deffn
6103
6104 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6105 Command disables watchdog timer.
6106 @end deffn
6107 @end deffn
6108
6109 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
6110 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6111 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6112 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6113 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6114
6115 @quotation Note
6116 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6117 driver:
6118 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6119 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6120 @end quotation
6121
6122 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6123 which must appear in the following order:
6124
6125 @itemize
6126 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6127 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6128 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6129 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6130 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6131 LPC43x[2357])
6132 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6133 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6134 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6135 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6136 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6137 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6138 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6139 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6140 at which the core is running
6141 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6142 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6143 @quotation Note
6144 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6145 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6146 However, if you do provide it,
6147 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6148 @end quotation
6149 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6150 ROM IAP entry point.
6151 @end itemize
6152
6153 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6154
6155 @example
6156 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6157 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6158 @end example
6159
6160 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6161 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6162 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6163 @end deffn
6164 @end deffn
6165
6166 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
6167 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6168 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6169 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6170 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6171 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6172
6173 @example
6174 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6175 @end example
6176 @end deffn
6177
6178 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
6179 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6180 from NXP.
6181
6182 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6183 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6184 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6185 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6186 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6187 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6188 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6189 you start the PLL.
6190
6191 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6192
6193 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6194 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6195 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6196
6197 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6198 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6199 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6200 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6201 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6202 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6203 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6204
6205 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6206 @example
6207 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6208 @end example
6209
6210 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6211 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6212 @code{flash banks} command.
6213
6214 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
6215 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6216 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6217 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6218 a known signature.
6219 Example:
6220 @example
6221 lpc2900 signature 0
6222 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6223 @end example
6224 @end deffn
6225
6226 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6227 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6228 saves it to a file in binary format.
6229 Example:
6230 @example
6231 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6232 @end example
6233 @end deffn
6234
6235 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6236 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6237 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6238 command:
6239
6240 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
6241 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6242 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6243 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6244
6245 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6246 Example:
6247 @example
6248 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6249 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6250 @end example
6251 @end deffn
6252
6253 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6254 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6255 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6256 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6257 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6258 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6259 912 bytes.
6260 @quotation Attention
6261 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6262 @end quotation
6263 Example:
6264 @example
6265 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6266 @end example
6267 @end deffn
6268
6269 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6270 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6271 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6272 after the next power cycle.
6273 @quotation Attention
6274 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6275 @end quotation
6276 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6277 Example:
6278 @example
6279 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6280 flash info 0
6281 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6282 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6283 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6284 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6285 @end example
6286 @end deffn
6287
6288 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6289 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6290 effective after the next power cycle.
6291 @quotation Attention
6292 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6293 @end quotation
6294 Examples:
6295 @example
6296 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6297 @end example
6298 @end deffn
6299 @end deffn
6300
6301 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
6302 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6303 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6304 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6305
6306 @example
6307 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6308 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6309 @end example
6310
6311 @itemize @bullet
6312 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6313 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6314 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6315 @end itemize
6316
6317 Example usage:
6318 @example
6319 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6320 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6321 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6322 @} else @{
6323 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6324 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6325 @}
6326 @end example
6327 @end deffn
6328
6329 @deffn {Flash Driver} msp432
6330 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6331 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6332 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6333 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
6334 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
6335
6336 @example
6337 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6338 @end example
6339
6340 @deffn Command {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
6341 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6342 only the main program flash.
6343
6344 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6345 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6346 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6347 @end deffn
6348
6349 @deffn Command {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
6350 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6351 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6352 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6353
6354 To erase and program the BSL:
6355 @example
6356 msp432 bsl unlock
6357 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6358 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6359 msp432 bsl lock
6360 @end example
6361 @end deffn
6362 @end deffn
6363
6364 @deffn {Flash Driver} niietcm4
6365 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6366 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6367 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6368 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6369 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6370 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6371 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6372 also have division into regions: main and info.
6373 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6374 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6375
6376 @example
6377 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6378 @end example
6379
6380 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6381
6382 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6383 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6384 @end deffn
6385
6386 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6387 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6388 @end deffn
6389
6390 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6391 Erase all userflash including info region.
6392 @end deffn
6393
6394 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6395 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6396 @end deffn
6397
6398 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6399 Check sectors protect.
6400 @end deffn
6401
6402 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6403 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6404 @end deffn
6405
6406 @deffn Command {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6407 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6408 @end deffn
6409
6410 @deffn Command {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6411 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6412 @end deffn
6413
6414 @deffn Command {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6415 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6416 @end deffn
6417
6418 @deffn Command {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6419 Show information about flash driver.
6420 @end deffn
6421
6422 @end deffn
6423
6424 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf5
6425 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6426 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
6427 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
6428 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
6429
6430 @example
6431 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6432 @end example
6433
6434 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6435
6436 @deffn Command {nrf5 mass_erase}
6437 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6438 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6439 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6440 code.
6441 @end deffn
6442
6443 @deffn Command {nrf5 info}
6444 Decodes and shows informations from FICR and UICR registers.
6445 @end deffn
6446
6447 @end deffn
6448
6449 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
6450 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6451 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6452
6453 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6454 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6455 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6456 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6457
6458 @example
6459 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6460 @end example
6461 @end deffn
6462
6463 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
6464 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6465 and integrate flash memory.
6466
6467 @example
6468 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6469 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6470 @end example
6471
6472 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6473 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6474 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6475 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6476 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6477 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6478 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6479 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6480 @end deffn
6481 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
6482 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6483 This will remove any Code Protection.
6484 @end deffn
6485 @end deffn
6486
6487 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
6488 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6489 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6490 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6491 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6492
6493 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6494 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6495
6496 @example
6497 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6498 @end example
6499
6500 psoc4-specific commands
6501 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6502 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6503
6504 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6505 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6506
6507 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6508 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6509 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6510
6511 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6512 @end deffn
6513
6514 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6515 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6516
6517 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6518 @end deffn
6519 @end deffn
6520
6521 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp
6522 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6523 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6524 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6525 apart from the base address.
6526
6527 @example
6528 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6529 @end example
6530
6531 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6532 @quotation Attention
6533 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6534 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6535 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6536 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6537 @end quotation
6538
6539 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6540
6541 @deffn Command {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6542 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6543 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6544 @end deffn
6545 @end deffn
6546
6547 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_eeprom
6548 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6549 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6550 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6551 apart from the base address.
6552
6553 @example
6554 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6555 @end example
6556 @end deffn
6557
6558 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_nvl
6559 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6560 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6561 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6562
6563 @example
6564 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6565 @end example
6566
6567 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
6568
6569 @itemize
6570 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
6571 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
6572 @end itemize
6573
6574 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
6575
6576 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
6577 @quotation Attention
6578 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
6579 after successful write.
6580 @end quotation
6581 @end deffn
6582
6583 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc6
6584 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
6585 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
6586 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
6587
6588 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
6589 @itemize @bullet
6590 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
6591 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
6592 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
6593 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
6594 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
6595 row size: 512 bytes.
6596 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
6597 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
6598 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
6599 operation will erase row automatically.
6600 @end itemize
6601
6602 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
6603 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
6604
6605 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
6606
6607 @example
6608 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6609 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6610 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6611 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6612 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6613 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6614
6615 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6616 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6617 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6618 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6619 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6620 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6621 @end example
6622
6623 psoc6-specific commands
6624 @deffn Command {psoc6 reset_halt}
6625 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
6626 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
6627 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
6628 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
6629 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
6630 @end deffn
6631
6632 @deffn Command {psoc6 mass_erase} num
6633 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
6634 by @command{flash banks}.
6635 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
6636 @end deffn
6637 @end deffn
6638
6639 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
6640 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
6641 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
6642 and SWD interface.
6643 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
6644 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
6645
6646 @example
6647 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6648 @end example
6649
6650 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
6651
6652 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
6653 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
6654 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
6655 @end deffn
6656
6657 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
6658 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
6659 @end deffn
6660 @end deffn
6661
6662 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
6663 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
6664 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
6665 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
6666 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6667
6668 @example
6669 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6670 @end example
6671
6672 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
6673 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
6674 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
6675 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
6676 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
6677 disabled.
6678
6679 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
6680 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
6681 @quotation Warning
6682 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
6683 applied to all of them.
6684 @end quotation
6685 @end deffn
6686 @end deffn
6687
6688 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
6689 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
6690 from STMicroelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
6691 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6692 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6693
6694 @example
6695 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6696 @end example
6697
6698 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6699 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6700 the flash driver.
6701
6702 @example
6703 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6704 @end example
6705
6706 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
6707 as per the following example.
6708 @example
6709 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6710 @end example
6711
6712 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
6713
6714 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
6715 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
6716 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6717 @end deffn
6718
6719 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
6720 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
6721 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
6722 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6723 @end deffn
6724
6725 @deffn Command {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
6726 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
6727 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6728 @end deffn
6729
6730 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
6731 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
6732 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
6733 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6734 @end deffn
6735
6736 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
6737 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
6738 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6739 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
6740 @end deffn
6741
6742 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_load} num
6743 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
6744 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
6745 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
6746 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6747 @end deffn
6748 @end deffn
6749
6750 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
6751 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6752 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
6753 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6754 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6755
6756 @example
6757 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6758 @end example
6759
6760 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
6761 as per the following example.
6762 @example
6763 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6764 @end example
6765
6766 @deffn Command {stm32f2x otp } num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
6767 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
6768 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6769 @end deffn
6770
6771 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6772 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6773 the flash driver.
6774
6775 @example
6776 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6777 @end example
6778
6779 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
6780
6781 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
6782 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6783 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6784 @end deffn
6785
6786 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
6787 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6788 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6789 @end deffn
6790
6791 @deffn Command {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
6792 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
6793 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6794 @end deffn
6795
6796 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_read} num
6797 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
6798 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6799 @end deffn
6800
6801 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
6802 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
6803 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
6804 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
6805 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
6806 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
6807 @end deffn
6808
6809 @deffn Command {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
6810 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
6811 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
6812 @end deffn
6813 @end deffn
6814
6815 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32h7x
6816 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6817 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
6818 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6819 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6820
6821 @example
6822 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6823 @end example
6824
6825 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6826 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6827 the flash driver.
6828
6829 @example
6830 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6831 @end example
6832
6833 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
6834
6835 @deffn Command {stm32h7x lock} num
6836 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6837 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6838 @end deffn
6839
6840 @deffn Command {stm32h7x unlock} num
6841 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6842 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6843 @end deffn
6844
6845 @deffn Command {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
6846 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
6847 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6848 @end deffn
6849
6850 @deffn Command {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
6851 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
6852 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6853 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
6854 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
6855
6856 Example usage:
6857 @example
6858 # read OPTSR_CUR
6859 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
6860 # read WPSN_CUR1R
6861 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
6862 # read WPSN_CUR2R
6863 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
6864 @end example
6865 @end deffn
6866
6867 @deffn Command {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
6868 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
6869 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6870 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
6871 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
6872 will be touched).
6873
6874 Example usage:
6875 @example
6876 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices, by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
6877 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
6878 @end example
6879 @end deffn
6880 @end deffn
6881
6882 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
6883 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6884 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
6885 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6886 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6887
6888 @example
6889 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6890 @end example
6891
6892 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6893 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6894 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
6895 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
6896 second bank.
6897
6898 @example
6899 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6900 @end example
6901
6902 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
6903
6904 @deffn Command {stm32lx lock} num
6905 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6906 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6907 @end deffn
6908
6909 @deffn Command {stm32lx unlock} num
6910 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6911 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6912 @end deffn
6913
6914 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
6915 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
6916 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
6917 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
6918 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6919 @end deffn
6920 @end deffn
6921
6922 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32l4x
6923 All members of the STM32L4, STM32L4+, STM32WB, STM32WL and STM32G4
6924 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
6925 and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6926 Additionally this driver supports STM32G0 family with ARM Cortex-M0+ core.
6927 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6928 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6929
6930 @example
6931 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6932 @end example
6933
6934 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6935 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6936 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
6937 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
6938
6939 @example
6940 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6941 @end example
6942
6943 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
6944
6945 @deffn Command {stm32l4x lock} num
6946 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6947 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6948 @end deffn
6949
6950 @deffn Command {stm32l4x unlock} num
6951 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6952 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6953 @end deffn
6954
6955 @deffn Command {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
6956 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
6957 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6958 @end deffn
6959
6960 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
6961 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
6962 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6963 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
6964
6965 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
6966 @example
6967 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
6968 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
6969 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
6970 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
6971 @end example
6972
6973 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
6974 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
6975 @end deffn
6976
6977 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
6978 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
6979 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6980 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
6981 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
6982
6983 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
6984 @example
6985 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
6986 @end example
6987
6988 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
6989 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
6990 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
6991 @end deffn
6992
6993 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_load} num
6994 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
6995 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6996 @end deffn
6997 @end deffn
6998
6999 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
7000 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7001 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7002 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
7003 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
7004
7005 @example
7006 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
7007 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
7008 @end example
7009
7010 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
7011 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
7012 for the specified flash bank.
7013 @end deffn
7014 @end deffn
7015
7016 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
7017 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7018 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
7019 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
7020 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
7021
7022 @example
7023 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7024 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
7025 @end example
7026
7027 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
7028 Configures the str9 flash controller.
7029 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7030
7031 @itemize @bullet
7032 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
7033 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
7034 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7035 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7036 @end itemize
7037 @end deffn
7038
7039 @end deffn
7040
7041 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
7042 @cindex str9xpec
7043
7044 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
7045 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
7046 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
7047 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
7048
7049 Here is some background info to help
7050 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
7051 the str9:
7052 @enumerate
7053 @item
7054 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7055 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7056 @item
7057 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7058 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7059 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7060 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7061 @end enumerate
7062
7063 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7064 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7065 configured for flash bank 0.
7066 @example
7067 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7068 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7069 adapter assert srst
7070 # turn off target polling
7071 poll off
7072 # disable str9 core
7073 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7074 # read option bytes
7075 str9xpec options_read 0
7076 # re-enable str9 core
7077 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7078 poll on
7079 reset halt
7080 @end example
7081 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7082 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7083 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7084 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7085
7086 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7087
7088 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7089 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7090 @end deffn
7091
7092 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7093 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7094 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7095 @end deffn
7096
7097 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
7098 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7099 erase the device.
7100 @end deffn
7101
7102 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
7103 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7104 @end deffn
7105
7106 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7107 Configure str9 boot bank.
7108 @end deffn
7109
7110 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7111 Configure str9 lvd source.
7112 @end deffn
7113
7114 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7115 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7116 @end deffn
7117
7118 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7119 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7120 @end deffn
7121
7122 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
7123 Read str9 option bytes.
7124 @end deffn
7125
7126 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
7127 Write str9 option bytes.
7128 @end deffn
7129
7130 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
7131 unlock str9 device.
7132 @end deffn
7133
7134 @end deffn
7135
7136 @deffn {Flash Driver} swm050
7137 @cindex swm050
7138 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7139
7140 @example
7141 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7142 @end example
7143
7144 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7145
7146 @deffn Command {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7147 Erases the entire flash bank.
7148 @end deffn
7149
7150 @end deffn
7151
7152
7153 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
7154 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7155 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7156 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7157
7158 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7159
7160 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7161 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7162 @end deffn
7163
7164 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
7165 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7166 @end deffn
7167
7168 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
7169 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
7170 the flash clock.
7171 @end deffn
7172 @end deffn
7173
7174 @deffn {Flash Driver} w600
7175 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
7176 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
7177 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
7178 correct bank config.
7179
7180 @example
7181 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7182 @end example
7183 @end deffn
7184
7185 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc1xxx
7186 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7187 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7188 @end deffn
7189
7190 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc4xxx
7191 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7192 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7193
7194 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7195
7196 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7197 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7198 @end deffn
7199
7200 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
7201 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
7202 @end deffn
7203
7204 @end deffn
7205
7206 @section NAND Flash Commands
7207 @cindex NAND
7208
7209 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
7210 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
7211 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
7212
7213 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
7214 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
7215 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
7216 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
7217 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
7218 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
7219
7220 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
7221 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
7222 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
7223 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
7224 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
7225 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
7226 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
7227 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
7228 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
7229 with techniques such as wear leveling.
7230
7231 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
7232 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
7233 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
7234 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
7235 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
7236 every 512 bytes of data.
7237
7238 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
7239 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
7240 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
7241 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
7242 ECC mode is used.
7243
7244 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
7245 @enumerate
7246 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
7247 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
7248 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
7249 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
7250 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
7251 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
7252 to access that device.
7253 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
7254 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
7255 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
7256 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
7257 de-brick a board.
7258 @end enumerate
7259
7260 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
7261 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
7262 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
7263 are only 32 bits wide.
7264 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
7265 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
7266 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
7267 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
7268
7269 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
7270 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
7271 @cindex NAND configuration
7272
7273 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
7274 plus some additional configuration that's done after
7275 OpenOCD has initialized.
7276
7277 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7278 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7279 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7280 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7281 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7282 they were a single (larger) device.
7283 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7284 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7285
7286 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7287 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7288 configuration files, not interactively.
7289
7290 @itemize @bullet
7291 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7292 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7293 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7294 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7295 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7296 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7297 commands to the NAND controller.
7298 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7299 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7300 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7301 for more information.
7302 @end itemize
7303 @end deffn
7304
7305 @deffn Command {nand list}
7306 Prints a summary of each device declared
7307 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7308 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7309 @example
7310 > nand list
7311 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7312 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7313 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7314 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7315 >
7316 @end example
7317 @end deffn
7318
7319 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
7320 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7321 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7322 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7323 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7324 it with most other NAND commands.
7325 @end deffn
7326
7327 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7328
7329 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7330 @cindex NAND reading
7331 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7332 starting at the specified offset.
7333 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7334
7335 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7336 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7337
7338 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7339 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7340 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7341
7342 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7343 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7344 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7345 method which handled that error correction.
7346
7347 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7348 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7349 @itemize @bullet
7350 @item no oob_* parameter
7351 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7352 @item @code{oob_raw}
7353 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7354 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7355 spare areas associated with each data page.
7356 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7357 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7358 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7359 @item @code{oob_only}
7360 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7361 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7362 spare areas associated with each data page.
7363 @end itemize
7364 @end deffn
7365
7366 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
7367 @cindex NAND erasing
7368 @cindex NAND programming
7369 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7370 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7371 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7372 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7373 If those parameters are not specified,
7374 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7375 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7376
7377 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7378 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7379 block marker.
7380 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7381 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7382 @end deffn
7383
7384 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7385 @cindex NAND writing
7386 @cindex NAND programming
7387 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7388 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7389 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7390 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7391
7392 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7393 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7394
7395 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7396 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7397 past the end of the device.
7398 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7399 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7400 if that's being written.)
7401
7402 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7403 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7404 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7405
7406 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7407 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7408 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7409 @itemize @bullet
7410 @item no oob_* parameter
7411 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7412 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7413 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7414 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7415 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7416 @item @code{oob_only}
7417 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7418 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7419 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7420 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7421 @item @code{oob_raw}
7422 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7423 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7424 un-altered OOB.
7425 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7426 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7427 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7428 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7429 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7430 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7431 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7432 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7433 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7434 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7435 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7436 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7437 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7438 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7439 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7440 @end itemize
7441 @end deffn
7442
7443 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7444 @cindex NAND verification
7445 @cindex NAND programming
7446 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7447 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7448 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7449
7450 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7451 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7452
7453 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7454 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7455 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7456 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7457 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7458
7459 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7460 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7461 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7462
7463 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7464 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7465 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7466 be removed in a future release.
7467 @end deffn
7468
7469 @subsection Other NAND commands
7470 @cindex NAND other commands
7471
7472 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7473 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7474 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7475 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7476 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7477 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7478 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7479 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7480
7481 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7482 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7483 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7484 @end deffn
7485
7486 @deffn Command {nand info} num
7487 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7488 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7489 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7490 status for each block.
7491 @end deffn
7492
7493 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7494 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7495 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7496
7497 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7498 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7499 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
7500 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
7501 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
7502
7503 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
7504 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
7505 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
7506 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
7507 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
7508 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
7509 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
7510 @end deffn
7511
7512 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
7513 @subsection NAND Driver List
7514 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
7515 driver-specific options and behaviors.
7516 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
7517
7518 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
7519 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
7520 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
7521 address of the ECC controller.
7522 @example
7523 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
7524 @end example
7525 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
7526 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
7527 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
7528 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
7529 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
7530 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
7531 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
7532 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7533 @end deffn
7534 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
7535 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
7536 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7537 @end deffn
7538
7539 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
7540 properly configured for input or output.
7541 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
7542 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
7543 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7544 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7545 @end deffn
7546 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
7547 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
7548 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7549 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7550 @end deffn
7551 @end deffn
7552
7553 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
7554 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
7555 chips from Texas Instruments.
7556 It takes three extra parameters:
7557 address of the NAND chip;
7558 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
7559 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
7560 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
7561 @example
7562 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
7563 @end example
7564 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
7565 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
7566 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
7567 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
7568 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
7569 @end deffn
7570
7571 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
7572 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7573 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
7574 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
7575 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
7576 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
7577 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7578 @end deffn
7579
7580 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
7581 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
7582 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
7583 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
7584 @end deffn
7585 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
7586
7587 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
7588 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
7589 should work for this chip as well.
7590 @end deffn
7591
7592 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
7593 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
7594 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
7595 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
7596 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
7597 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
7598 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
7599 @example
7600 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
7601 @end example
7602 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
7603 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
7604 without parameter query status.
7605 @end deffn
7606 @end deffn
7607
7608 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
7609 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7610 parameter: the address of the controller.
7611 @example
7612 nand device orion 0xd8000000
7613 @end example
7614 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
7615 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7616 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7617 change any behavior.
7618 @end deffn
7619
7620 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
7621 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
7622 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
7623 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
7624 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
7625 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
7626 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
7627 specialized commands.
7628 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7629 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7630 change any behavior.
7631 @end deffn
7632
7633 @node Flash Programming
7634 @chapter Flash Programming
7635
7636 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
7637 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
7638 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
7639
7640 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
7641 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
7642
7643 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
7644 @enumerate
7645 @item 'init' is executed.
7646 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
7647 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
7648 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
7649 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
7650 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
7651 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
7652 @end enumerate
7653
7654 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
7655
7656 @example
7657 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
7658 # are optional parameters
7659 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7660 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
7661
7662 # binary files need the flash address passing
7663 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7664 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
7665 @end example
7666
7667 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
7668 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
7669 @cindex PLD
7670 @cindex FPGA
7671
7672 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
7673 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
7674 OpenOCD can support programming them.
7675 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
7676 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
7677 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
7678 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
7679
7680 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
7681
7682 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
7683 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
7684 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
7685
7686 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
7687 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
7688
7689 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
7690 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
7691 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
7692 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
7693 behavior.
7694 @end deffn
7695
7696 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
7697 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
7698 @end deffn
7699
7700 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
7701 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
7702 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
7703 @end deffn
7704
7705 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
7706
7707 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
7708 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
7709 that particular type of PLD.
7710
7711 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
7712 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
7713 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
7714
7715 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
7716 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
7717 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
7718
7719 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
7720 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
7721 for FPGA @var{num}.
7722 @end deffn
7723 @end deffn
7724
7725 @node General Commands
7726 @chapter General Commands
7727 @cindex commands
7728
7729 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
7730 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
7731 commands are documented elsewhere.
7732
7733 Intent:
7734 @itemize @bullet
7735 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
7736 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
7737 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
7738 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
7739
7740 @item @b{From the human}
7741 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
7742 or via GDB (default port 3333).
7743
7744 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
7745 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
7746 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
7747
7748 @item @b{Machine Interface}
7749 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
7750 port is 5555.
7751 @end itemize
7752
7753
7754 @section Server Commands
7755
7756 @deffn {Command} exit
7757 Exits the current telnet session.
7758 @end deffn
7759
7760 @deffn {Command} help [string]
7761 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
7762 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
7763 Not every command provides helptext.
7764
7765 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
7766 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
7767 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
7768 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
7769 @end deffn
7770
7771 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
7772 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
7773 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
7774 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
7775 Useful in connection with script files
7776 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
7777 @end deffn
7778
7779 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
7780 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
7781 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
7782 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
7783
7784 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
7785 @example
7786 # redefine shutdown
7787 rename shutdown original_shutdown
7788 proc shutdown @{@} @{
7789 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
7790 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
7791 original_shutdown
7792 @}
7793 @end example
7794 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
7795 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
7796 @end deffn
7797
7798 @anchor{debuglevel}
7799 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
7800 @cindex message level
7801 Display debug level.
7802 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
7803 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
7804 Level 0 is error messages only;
7805 level 1 adds warnings;
7806 level 2 adds informational messages;
7807 level 3 adds debugging messages;
7808 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
7809 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
7810 the command line along with the location of that log
7811 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
7812 @xref{Running}.
7813 @end deffn
7814
7815 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
7816 Logs a message at "user" priority.
7817 Output @var{message} to stdout.
7818 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
7819 @example
7820 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
7821 @end example
7822 @end deffn
7823
7824 @deffn Command log_output [filename | "default"]
7825 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
7826 the default log output channel is stderr.
7827 @end deffn
7828
7829 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
7830 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
7831 @end deffn
7832
7833 @deffn Command bindto [@var{name}]
7834 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
7835 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
7836 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
7837 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
7838 @end deffn
7839
7840 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
7841 @section Target State handling
7842 @cindex reset
7843 @cindex halt
7844 @cindex target initialization
7845
7846 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
7847 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
7848 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
7849 a current target which is used to perform the
7850 various operations. The current target may be changed
7851 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
7852 target which should become current.
7853
7854 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
7855 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
7856 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
7857 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
7858 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
7859
7860 @emph{With no arguments}:
7861 list all available registers for the current target,
7862 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
7863 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
7864 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
7865 are flagged as such.
7866
7867 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
7868 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
7869 bypassing any internal cache.
7870
7871 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
7872 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
7873 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
7874 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
7875 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
7876 relevant module will flush such values.
7877
7878 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
7879 Debug and trace infrastructure:
7880
7881 @example
7882 > reg
7883 ===== ARM registers
7884 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
7885 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
7886 (2) r2 (/32)
7887 ...
7888 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
7889 >
7890 @end example
7891 @end deffn
7892
7893 @deffn Command halt [ms]
7894 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
7895 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
7896 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
7897 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
7898 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
7899 (and enter debug mode).
7900 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
7901
7902 @quotation Warning
7903 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
7904 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
7905 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
7906 power mode by gating the core clock;
7907 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
7908
7909 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
7910 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
7911 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
7912 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
7913 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
7914 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
7915
7916 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
7917 work with a JTAG debugger.
7918 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
7919 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
7920 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
7921 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
7922 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
7923 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
7924 @end quotation
7925
7926 @end deffn
7927
7928 @deffn Command resume [address]
7929 Resume the target at its current code position,
7930 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
7931 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
7932 @end deffn
7933
7934 @deffn Command step [address]
7935 Single-step the target at its current code position,
7936 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
7937 @end deffn
7938
7939 @anchor{resetcommand}
7940 @deffn Command reset
7941 @deffnx Command {reset run}
7942 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
7943 @deffnx Command {reset init}
7944 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
7945 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
7946 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
7947
7948 The optional parameter specifies what should
7949 happen after the reset.
7950 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
7951 The other options will not work on all systems.
7952 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
7953
7954 @itemize @minus
7955 @item @b{run} Let the target run
7956 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
7957 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
7958 @end itemize
7959 @end deffn
7960
7961 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
7962 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
7963 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
7964 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
7965 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
7966 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
7967 state.
7968 @end deffn
7969
7970 @deffn Command {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
7971 @deffnx Command {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
7972 Set values of reset signals.
7973 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
7974 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
7975 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
7976 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
7977
7978 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
7979 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
7980 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
7981 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
7982 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
7983 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
7984 the signal will not be modified.
7985
7986 @quotation Note
7987 TRST is specially handled.
7988 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
7989 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
7990 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
7991 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
7992 instead of the TRST signal.
7993 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
7994 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
7995 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
7996 with handlers for that event.
7997 @end quotation
7998 @end deffn
7999
8000 @section I/O Utilities
8001
8002 These commands are available when
8003 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
8004 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
8005 notably the ZY1000.
8006 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
8007
8008 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
8009
8010 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
8011 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
8012 the text file @file{filename}.
8013 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
8014 The last string is followed by a newline.
8015 @end deffn
8016
8017 @deffn Command cat filename
8018 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
8019 @end deffn
8020
8021 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
8022 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
8023 into @file{dest_filename}.
8024 @end deffn
8025
8026 @deffn Command ip
8027 @emph{No description provided.}
8028 @end deffn
8029
8030 @deffn Command ls
8031 @emph{No description provided.}
8032 @end deffn
8033
8034 @deffn Command mac
8035 @emph{No description provided.}
8036 @end deffn
8037
8038 @deffn Command meminfo
8039 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
8040 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
8041 @end deffn
8042
8043 @deffn Command peek
8044 @emph{No description provided.}
8045 @end deffn
8046
8047 @deffn Command poke
8048 @emph{No description provided.}
8049 @end deffn
8050
8051 @deffn Command rm filename
8052 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
8053 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
8054 @end deffn
8055
8056 @deffn Command trunc filename
8057 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
8058 @end deffn
8059
8060 @anchor{memoryaccess}
8061 @section Memory access commands
8062 @cindex memory access
8063
8064 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
8065 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
8066 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
8067 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
8068
8069 @enumerate
8070 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
8071 to change the current target.
8072 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
8073 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
8074 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
8075 @end enumerate
8076
8077 @deffn Command mdd [phys] addr [count]
8078 @deffnx Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
8079 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
8080 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
8081 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8082 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8083 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8084 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8085 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8086 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8087 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8088 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8089 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8090 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
8091 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
8092 @end deffn
8093
8094 @deffn Command mwd [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8095 @deffnx Command mww [phys] addr word [count]
8096 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword [count]
8097 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte [count]
8098 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8099 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8100 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8101 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8102 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8103 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8104 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8105 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8106 @end deffn
8107
8108 @anchor{imageaccess}
8109 @section Image loading commands
8110 @cindex image loading
8111 @cindex image dumping
8112
8113 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
8114 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8115 binary file named @var{filename}.
8116 @end deffn
8117
8118 @deffn Command {fast_load}
8119 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8120 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8121 @end deffn
8122
8123 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8124 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8125 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8126 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8127 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8128 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8129 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8130 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8131 separately.
8132 @end deffn
8133
8134 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8135 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8136 The file format may optionally be specified
8137 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8138 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8139 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8140 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8141 @example
8142 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8143 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8144 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8145 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
8146 $address $length
8147 @}
8148 @end example
8149 @end deffn
8150
8151 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
8152 Displays image section sizes and addresses
8153 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8154 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8155 The file format may optionally be specified
8156 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8157 @end deffn
8158
8159 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8160 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8161 The file format may optionally be specified
8162 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8163 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8164 @end deffn
8165
8166 @deffn Command {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8167 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8168 The file format may optionally be specified
8169 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8170 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8171 @end deffn
8172
8173
8174 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8175 @cindex breakpoint
8176 @cindex watchpoint
8177
8178 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8179 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8180 watchpoints.
8181 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
8182
8183 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
8184 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
8185 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
8186 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8187 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
8188 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
8189
8190 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
8191 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
8192 @end deffn
8193
8194 @deffn Command {rbp} @option{all} | address
8195 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
8196 @end deffn
8197
8198 @deffn Command {rwp} address
8199 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
8200 @end deffn
8201
8202 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
8203 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
8204 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8205 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
8206 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
8207 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
8208 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
8209 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
8210 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
8211 @end deffn
8212
8213 @section Misc Commands
8214
8215 @cindex profiling
8216 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
8217 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
8218 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
8219 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
8220 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
8221 limit the address range.
8222 @end deffn
8223
8224 @deffn Command {version}
8225 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
8226 @end deffn
8227
8228 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
8229 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
8230 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
8231 @end deffn
8232
8233 @node Architecture and Core Commands
8234 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
8235 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
8236 @cindex Core Specific Commands
8237
8238 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
8239 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
8240 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
8241 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
8242
8243 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
8244 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
8245 @cindex tracing
8246 @cindex ETM
8247 @cindex ETB
8248
8249 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
8250 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
8251 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8252
8253 @itemize
8254 @item
8255 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8256 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8257 supports such an interface.
8258 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8259 and trace port support.)
8260 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8261 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8262 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8263 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8264 in the board-specific configuration file.
8265 @item
8266 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8267 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8268 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8269 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8270 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8271 @end itemize
8272
8273 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8274
8275 @quotation Issues
8276 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8277 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8278
8279 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8280 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8281 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8282 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8283 dummy trace port driver}.
8284
8285 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8286 as well as tracing only during specific states
8287 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8288
8289 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8290 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8291 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8292 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8293 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8294
8295 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8296 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8297 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8298 this original style of JTAG access.
8299 @end quotation
8300
8301 @subsection ETM Configuration
8302 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8303
8304 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8305 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8306 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8307
8308 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8309 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8310 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8311 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8312 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8313 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8314 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8315 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8316 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8317
8318 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8319 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8320 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8321
8322 @quotation Warning
8323 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8324 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8325 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8326 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8327 @end quotation
8328
8329 @quotation Note
8330 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8331 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8332 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8333 what CPU activities are traced.
8334 @end quotation
8335 @end deffn
8336
8337 @deffn Command {etm info}
8338 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8339 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8340 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8341 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8342 @end deffn
8343
8344 @deffn Command {etm status}
8345 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8346 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8347 Did trace data overflow?
8348 Was it triggered?
8349 @end deffn
8350
8351 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8352 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8353 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8354 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8355 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8356
8357 @itemize
8358 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8359 when they pass any ViewData filtering that that was set up.
8360 The value is one of
8361 @option{none} (save nothing),
8362 @option{data} (save data),
8363 @option{address} (save addresses),
8364 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8365 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8366 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8367 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8368 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8369 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8370 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8371 trace stream without an image of the code.
8372 @end itemize
8373 @end deffn
8374
8375 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8376 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8377 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8378 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8379 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8380
8381 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8382 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8383 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8384 @end deffn
8385
8386 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8387
8388 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8389 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8390 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8391
8392 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8393 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8394 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8395 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8396 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8397 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8398 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8399
8400 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8401
8402 @itemize
8403 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8404 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8405 for instruction access within that function's body.
8406 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8407 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8408 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8409 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8410 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8411 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8412 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8413 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8414 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8415 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8416 @item @emph{... more}
8417 @end itemize
8418
8419 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8420 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8421
8422 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
8423 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8424 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8425 @end deffn
8426
8427 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
8428 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8429 @end deffn
8430
8431 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8432 Opens an image file.
8433 @end deffn
8434
8435 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
8436 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8437 @end deffn
8438
8439 @deffn Command {etm start}
8440 Starts trace data collection.
8441 @end deffn
8442
8443 @deffn Command {etm stop}
8444 Stops trace data collection.
8445 @end deffn
8446
8447 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8448 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8449
8450 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8451
8452 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
8453 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8454 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8455 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8456 any trace data collection.}
8457 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
8458 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
8459 @end deffn
8460 @end deffn
8461
8462 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
8463 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
8464 to use on-chip ETB memory.
8465 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
8466 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
8467 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
8468 @end deffn
8469 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
8470 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
8471 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
8472 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
8473 trace trigger becomes active.
8474
8475 @itemize
8476 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
8477 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
8478 afterwards.
8479 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
8480 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
8481 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
8482 what caused that event to happen.
8483 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
8484 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
8485 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
8486 how the event caused trouble.
8487 @end itemize
8488 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
8489 @end deffn
8490
8491 @end deffn
8492
8493 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
8494 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
8495 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
8496 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
8497 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
8498
8499 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8500 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
8501
8502 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
8503 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
8504 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
8505 @end deffn
8506
8507 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
8508 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
8509 @end deffn
8510
8511 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
8512 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
8513 @end deffn
8514 @end deffn
8515
8516 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
8517 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
8518 @cindex CTI
8519
8520 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
8521 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
8522 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
8523 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
8524 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
8525 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
8526
8527 @deffn Command {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-ctibase} base_address
8528 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
8529 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
8530 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
8531 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
8532 including additional configuration.
8533 @end deffn
8534
8535 @deffn Command {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
8536 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
8537 @end deffn
8538
8539 @deffn Command {$cti_name dump}
8540 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
8541 @end deffn
8542
8543 @deffn Command {$cti_name write } @var{reg_name} @var{value}
8544 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8545 @end deffn
8546
8547 @deffn Command {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
8548 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8549 @end deffn
8550
8551 @deffn Command {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
8552 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
8553 @end deffn
8554
8555 @deffn Command {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
8556 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
8557 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
8558 @end deffn
8559
8560 @deffn Command {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
8561 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
8562 of the CTI.
8563 @end deffn
8564
8565 @deffn Command {cti names}
8566 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
8567 useful in TCL scripting.
8568 @end deffn
8569
8570 @section Generic ARM
8571 @cindex ARM
8572
8573 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
8574 They are available in addition to other core-specific
8575 commands that may be available.
8576
8577 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
8578 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
8579 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
8580 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
8581 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8582 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
8583 @end deffn
8584
8585 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
8586 @cindex disassemble
8587 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
8588 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
8589 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
8590 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
8591 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
8592 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8593 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
8594
8595 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
8596 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
8597 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
8598 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
8599 with a handful of exceptions.
8600 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
8601 @end deffn
8602
8603 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
8604 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
8605 passing parameters @var{CRn},
8606 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8607 and using the MCR instruction.
8608 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8609 an ARM register.)
8610 @end deffn
8611
8612 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
8613 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
8614 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8615 and the MRC instruction.
8616 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
8617 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8618 an ARM register.)
8619 @end deffn
8620
8621 @deffn Command {arm reg}
8622 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
8623 core mode if necessary.
8624 @end deffn
8625
8626 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8627 @cindex ARM semihosting
8628 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
8629
8630 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
8631 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
8632 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
8633 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
8634 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
8635 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
8636 @end deffn
8637
8638 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8639 @cindex ARM semihosting
8640 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
8641
8642 @example
8643 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
8644 @end example
8645
8646 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
8647 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
8648 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
8649 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
8650 @end deffn
8651
8652 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8653 @cindex ARM semihosting
8654 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
8655 status.
8656
8657 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
8658 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
8659 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
8660 debugger.
8661 @end deffn
8662
8663 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8664 @cindex ARM semihosting
8665 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
8666
8667 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
8668 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
8669 the value returned by the target.
8670
8671 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
8672 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
8673 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
8674 encountering a break.
8675
8676 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
8677 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
8678 to the debugger.
8679 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
8680 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
8681 request or equivalent").
8682
8683 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
8684 this option (default: disabled).
8685 @end deffn
8686
8687 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
8688 @cindex ARMv4
8689 @cindex ARMv5
8690
8691 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
8692 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
8693 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
8694 variant.
8695
8696 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
8697 @cindex ARM7
8698 @cindex ARM9
8699
8700 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
8701 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
8702 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
8703 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
8704
8705 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8706 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
8707 the EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
8708 instead of breakpoints.
8709 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8710
8711 This should be
8712 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
8713 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
8714 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
8715 @end deffn
8716
8717 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8718 @cindex DCC
8719 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
8720 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
8721 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8722
8723 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
8724 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
8725 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
8726 @end deffn
8727
8728 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8729 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
8730 that don't check completion of the operation.
8731 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8732
8733 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
8734 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
8735 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
8736 @end deffn
8737
8738 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
8739 @cindex ARM720T
8740
8741 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
8742 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8743 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
8744 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
8745
8746 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
8747 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8748 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8749
8750 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
8751 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8752 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
8753 @end deffn
8754
8755 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
8756 @cindex ARM9
8757
8758 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
8759 integer processors.
8760 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
8761
8762 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
8763 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
8764 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
8765 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
8766
8767 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
8768 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
8769 @cindex vector_catch
8770 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
8771 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
8772 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
8773 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
8774 to those hardware vectors.
8775
8776 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
8777 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
8778 vector catch hardware to intercept
8779 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
8780 @option{none} of them,
8781 or a list with one or more of the following:
8782 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
8783 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
8784 @end deffn
8785
8786 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
8787 @cindex ARM920T
8788
8789 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
8790 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8791 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
8792 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8793 and ARM9 commands.
8794
8795 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
8796 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
8797 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
8798 @end deffn
8799
8800 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
8801 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8802 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8803 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
8804 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
8805 (Not all registers can be written.)
8806 @end deffn
8807
8808 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
8809 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8810 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8811
8812 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
8813 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
8814 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
8815 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
8816 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
8817 or using zero if no other address is provided.
8818 @end deffn
8819
8820 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
8821 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
8822 @end deffn
8823
8824 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
8825 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
8826 @end deffn
8827
8828 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
8829 @cindex ARM926ej-s
8830
8831 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
8832 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
8833 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
8834 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8835 and ARM9 commands.
8836
8837 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
8838 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
8839
8840 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
8841 Print information about the caches found.
8842 @end deffn
8843
8844 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
8845 @cindex ARM966E
8846
8847 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
8848 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
8849 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8850 and ARM9 commands.
8851
8852 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
8853 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8854 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8855 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
8856 ARM966E-S TRM.
8857 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
8858 as required for BIST support.
8859 @end deffn
8860
8861 @subsection XScale specific commands
8862 @cindex XScale
8863
8864 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
8865
8866 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
8867 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
8868 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
8869 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
8870 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
8871 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
8872 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
8873
8874 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
8875 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
8876 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
8877 the mini-IC.
8878
8879 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
8880 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
8881 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
8882 code layout in memory:
8883 @example
8884 _vectors:
8885 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8886 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8887 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8888 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8889 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8890 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8891 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8892 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8893 .org 0x100
8894 .long real_reset_vector
8895 .long real_ui_handler
8896 .long real_swi_handler
8897 .long real_pf_abort
8898 .long real_data_abort
8899 .long 0 /* unused */
8900 .long real_irq_handler
8901 .long real_fiq_handler
8902 @end example
8903
8904 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
8905 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
8906 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
8907 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
8908 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
8909 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
8910 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
8911 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
8912 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
8913 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
8914 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
8915 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
8916 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
8917 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
8918 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
8919 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
8920 software.
8921
8922 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
8923 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
8924 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
8925 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
8926
8927 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
8928 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
8929 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
8930 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
8931 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
8932 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
8933 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
8934 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
8935 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
8936
8937 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
8938 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
8939
8940 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
8941 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
8942 @end deffn
8943
8944 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
8945 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
8946 @end deffn
8947
8948 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
8949 Displays information about the CPU caches.
8950 @end deffn
8951
8952 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
8953 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8954 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8955 @end deffn
8956
8957 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
8958 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
8959 @end deffn
8960
8961 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8962 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
8963 @end deffn
8964
8965 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
8966 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
8967 @end deffn
8968
8969 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8970 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
8971 @end deffn
8972
8973 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8974 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
8975 @end deffn
8976
8977 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
8978 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
8979 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
8980 and modifying how it is emptied.
8981 @end deffn
8982
8983 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
8984 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
8985 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
8986 The image @var{type} may be one of
8987 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
8988 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
8989 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
8990 @end deffn
8991
8992 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
8993 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
8994 @cindex vector_catch
8995 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
8996 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
8997
8998 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
8999 @example
9000 0x01 Trap Reset
9001 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
9002 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
9003 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
9004 0x10 Trap Data Abort
9005 0x20 reserved
9006 0x40 Trap IRQ
9007 0x80 Trap FIQ
9008 @end example
9009 @end deffn
9010
9011 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
9012 @cindex vector_table
9013
9014 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
9015 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
9016 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
9017 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
9018 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
9019
9020 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
9021
9022 @end deffn
9023
9024 @section ARMv6 Architecture
9025 @cindex ARMv6
9026
9027 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
9028 @cindex ARM11
9029
9030 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9031 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
9032 which is enabled by default.
9033 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9034 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
9035 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
9036 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
9037 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
9038 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
9039 @end deffn
9040
9041 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9042 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
9043 which is enabled by default.
9044 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9045 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
9046 @end deffn
9047
9048 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9049 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
9050 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
9051 they are disabled by default.
9052 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
9053 @end deffn
9054
9055 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
9056 @cindex vector_catch
9057 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
9058 coprocessor 14 register 7.
9059 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
9060
9061 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9062 for certain hardware events.
9063 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
9064 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
9065 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
9066 @end deffn
9067
9068 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
9069 @cindex ARMv7
9070 @cindex ARMv8
9071
9072 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
9073 @cindex Cortex-A
9074
9075 @deffn Command {cortex_a cache_info}
9076 display information about target caches
9077 @end deffn
9078
9079 @deffn Command {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
9080 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
9081 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
9082 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
9083 Defaults to 'off'.
9084 @end deffn
9085
9086 @deffn Command {cortex_a dbginit}
9087 Initialize core debug
9088 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9089 @end deffn
9090
9091 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
9092 Display/set the current SMP mode
9093 @end deffn
9094
9095 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
9096 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
9097 @end deffn
9098
9099 @deffn Command {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9100 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9101 @end deffn
9102
9103 @deffn Command {cache_config l2x} [base way]
9104 configure l2x cache
9105 @end deffn
9106
9107 @deffn Command {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
9108 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
9109 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
9110 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
9111 possible (4096) entries are printed.
9112 @end deffn
9113
9114 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
9115 @cindex Cortex-R
9116
9117 @deffn Command {cortex_r dbginit}
9118 Initialize core debug
9119 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9120 @end deffn
9121
9122 @deffn Command {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9123 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9124 @end deffn
9125
9126
9127 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
9128 @cindex tracing
9129 @cindex SWO
9130 @cindex SWV
9131 @cindex TPIU
9132 @cindex ITM
9133 @cindex ETM
9134
9135 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal (@var{filename} | -)}) @
9136 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
9137 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
9138
9139 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
9140 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
9141 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
9142 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
9143
9144 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
9145 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
9146 debugger adapter features.
9147
9148 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
9149 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
9150
9151 Command options:
9152 @itemize @minus
9153 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
9154 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
9155 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware);
9156 @item @option{internal @var{filename}} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
9157 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename} (which can be
9158 either a regular file or a named pipe);
9159 @item @option{internal -} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
9160 gather trace data, but not write to any file. Useful in conjunction with the @command{tcl_trace} command;
9161 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
9162 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width};
9163 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
9164 coding;
9165 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
9166 regular UART 8N1) coding;
9167 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
9168 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
9169 data is to be output via SWO;
9170 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
9171 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK);
9172 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
9173 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
9174 rate automatically.
9175 @end itemize
9176
9177 Example usage:
9178 @enumerate
9179 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
9180 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
9181 enough to:
9182 @example
9183 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
9184 ...
9185 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
9186 ...
9187 @end example
9188 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
9189 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
9190 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
9191 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
9192 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
9193 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
9194 @example
9195 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
9196 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
9197 @end example
9198 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
9199 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
9200 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
9201 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
9202 @example
9203 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
9204 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
9205 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
9206 -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
9207 @end example
9208 @end enumerate
9209 @end deffn
9210
9211 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9212 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
9213 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
9214 @end deffn
9215
9216 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9217 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
9218 @end deffn
9219
9220 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
9221 @cindex Cortex-M
9222
9223 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
9224 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
9225
9226 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
9227 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
9228 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
9229 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
9230 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
9231 the step command leaves with the core running.
9232
9233 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
9234 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
9235 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
9236 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
9237
9238 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
9239 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
9240 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
9241 does.
9242
9243 Default is @option{auto}.
9244 @end deffn
9245
9246 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9247 @cindex vector_catch
9248 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9249 for certain hardware events.
9250
9251 Parameters request interception of
9252 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
9253 @option{none} of them,
9254 or one or more of the following:
9255 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
9256 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
9257 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
9258 @option{irq_err},
9259 @option{state_err},
9260 @option{chk_err}, or
9261 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9262 @option{reset}.
9263 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9264 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9265 are mapped to HardFault.
9266 UsageFault checks for
9267 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9268 must also be explicitly enabled.
9269
9270 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9271 @end deffn
9272
9273 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9274 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9275 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9276
9277 @itemize @minus
9278 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9279 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9280 @end itemize
9281
9282 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9283 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9284 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9285 to manually reset the peripherals.
9286 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9287
9288 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9289 instead.
9290 @end deffn
9291
9292 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9293 @cindex ARMv8-A
9294 @cindex aarch64
9295
9296 @deffn Command {aarch64 cache_info}
9297 Display information about target caches
9298 @end deffn
9299
9300 @deffn Command {aarch64 dbginit}
9301 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9302 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9303 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9304 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9305 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9306 @end deffn
9307
9308 @deffn Command {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
9309 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9310 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9311 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9312 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9313 @end deffn
9314
9315 @deffn Command {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9316 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9317 @option{on}.
9318 @end deffn
9319
9320 @deffn Command {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
9321 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
9322 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
9323 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
9324 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
9325 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
9326 @end deffn
9327
9328 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9329
9330 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9331 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9332
9333 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9334
9335 @deffn Command {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9336 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9337 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9338 @end deffn
9339
9340 @deffn Command {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9341 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9342 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9343 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9344 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9345 @end deffn
9346
9347 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9348
9349 @deffn Command {esirisc flush_caches}
9350 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9351 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9352 @end deffn
9353
9354 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9355
9356 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9357 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9358 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9359 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9360 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9361 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9362 can be collected.
9363
9364 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9365 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9366 tooling.
9367
9368 @quotation Issues
9369 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9370 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9371 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9372 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9373
9374 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9375 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9376 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9377 software operation on the CPU.
9378 @end quotation
9379
9380 @deffn Command {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9381 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9382 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
9383 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
9384 @end deffn
9385
9386 @deffn Command {esirisc trace fifo} address
9387 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
9388 @end deffn
9389
9390 @deffn Command {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9391 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
9392 control is disabled.
9393 @end deffn
9394
9395 @deffn Command {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
9396 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
9397 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
9398 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
9399
9400 Supported trace formats:
9401 @itemize
9402 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
9403 timing to be determined.
9404 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
9405 addresses.
9406 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
9407 @end itemize
9408 @end deffn
9409
9410 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
9411 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
9412 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
9413 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9414
9415 Supported conditions:
9416 @itemize
9417 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
9418 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
9419 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
9420 instruction matches start data and mask.
9421 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
9422 instruction matches start data and mask.
9423 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
9424 data and mask.
9425 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9426 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9427 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9428 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
9429 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
9430 @end itemize
9431 @end deffn
9432
9433 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
9434 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
9435 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
9436 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9437
9438 Supported conditions:
9439 @itemize
9440 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
9441 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
9442 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
9443 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9444 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
9445 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9446 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
9447 data and mask.
9448 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9449 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9450 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9451 @end itemize
9452 @end deffn
9453
9454 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
9455 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
9456
9457 Supported triggers:
9458 @itemize
9459 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
9460 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
9461 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
9462 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
9463 collection.
9464 @end itemize
9465 @end deffn
9466
9467 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
9468
9469 @deffn Command {esirisc trace init}
9470 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
9471 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
9472 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
9473 @end deffn
9474
9475 @deffn Command {esirisc trace info}
9476 Display trace configuration.
9477 @end deffn
9478
9479 @deffn Command {esirisc trace status}
9480 Display trace collection status.
9481 @end deffn
9482
9483 @deffn Command {esirisc trace start}
9484 Start manual trace collection.
9485 @end deffn
9486
9487 @deffn Command {esirisc trace stop}
9488 Stop manual trace collection.
9489 @end deffn
9490
9491 @deffn Command {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
9492 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
9493 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
9494 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9495 @option{size} options using DMA.
9496 @end deffn
9497
9498 @deffn Command {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
9499 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
9500 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
9501 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9502 @option{size} options using DMA.
9503 @end deffn
9504
9505 @section Intel Architecture
9506
9507 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
9508 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
9509 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
9510 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
9511 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
9512 @itemize
9513 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
9514 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
9515 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
9516 @end itemize
9517
9518 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
9519 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
9520 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
9521
9522 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
9523 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9524 @end deffn
9525
9526 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
9527 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9528 @end deffn
9529
9530 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
9531 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9532 @end deffn
9533
9534 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
9535 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9536 @end deffn
9537
9538 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
9539 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9540 @end deffn
9541
9542 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
9543 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9544 @end deffn
9545
9546 @section OpenRISC Architecture
9547
9548 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
9549 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
9550
9551 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
9552 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
9553 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
9554 @end deffn
9555 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
9556 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
9557
9558 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
9559
9560 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
9561 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
9562 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
9563 @end deffn
9564
9565 @subsection Registers commands
9566 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
9567 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
9568 included in the generated target descriptor file.
9569
9570 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
9571
9572 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
9573 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
9574 and "timer" groups.
9575
9576 @emph{example:}
9577 @example
9578 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
9579 @end example
9580
9581
9582 @end deffn
9583 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
9584 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
9585
9586 @emph{group} can be "system",
9587 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
9588 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
9589 @end deffn
9590
9591 @section RISC-V Architecture
9592
9593 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
9594 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
9595 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
9596 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
9597 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
9598 implement version 0.11.
9599
9600 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
9601
9602 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
9603 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
9604 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
9605
9606 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
9607
9608 @deffn Command {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9609 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
9610 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
9611
9612 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
9613 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
9614 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
9615 CSRs.
9616 @end deffn
9617
9618 @deffn Command {riscv expose_custom} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9619 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
9620 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
9621 configures a list of inclusive ranges of those registers to expose. Number 0
9622 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
9623 This command must be executed before `init`.
9624 @end deffn
9625
9626 @deffn Command {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9627 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
9628 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
9629 @end deffn
9630
9631 @deffn Command {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9632 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
9633 deasserted.
9634 @end deffn
9635
9636 @deffn Command {riscv set_scratch_ram} none|[address]
9637 Set the address of 16 bytes of scratch RAM the debugger can use, or 'none'.
9638 This is used to access 64-bit floating point registers on 32-bit targets.
9639 @end deffn
9640
9641 @deffn Command {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
9642 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off, prefer to
9643 use the Program Buffer to access memory.
9644 @end deffn
9645
9646 @deffn Command {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
9647 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
9648 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
9649 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
9650 values.
9651
9652 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
9653 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
9654 and DBUS registers, respectively.
9655 @end deffn
9656
9657 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
9658
9659 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
9660 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
9661 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
9662 @example
9663 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
9664 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
9665 @end example
9666
9667 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_read}
9668 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
9669 @end deffn
9670
9671 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_write} value
9672 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
9673 @end deffn
9674
9675 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
9676
9677 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
9678 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
9679
9680 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_read}
9681 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
9682 @end deffn
9683
9684 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_write} address value
9685 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
9686 @end deffn
9687
9688 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
9689 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
9690 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
9691 @cindex tracing
9692 @cindex libdcc
9693 @cindex DCC
9694 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
9695 the target uses appropriate libraries.
9696 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
9697 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
9698
9699 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
9700 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
9701 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
9702 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
9703 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
9704 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
9705
9706 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
9707 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
9708 arrays of various size integers from the target,
9709 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
9710 The target being debugged may
9711 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
9712 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
9713 each supported by a command:
9714
9715 @itemize
9716 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
9717 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
9718 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
9719 finding out how some fault was triggered.
9720
9721 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
9722 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
9723 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
9724
9725 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
9726 and then displayed at any time.
9727 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
9728
9729 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
9730 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
9731 @end itemize
9732
9733 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
9734 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
9735 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
9736 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
9737 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
9738 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
9739 does the same thing.
9740
9741 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
9742 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
9743 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
9744 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
9745 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
9746
9747 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
9748 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
9749 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
9750 @end deffn
9751
9752 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
9753 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
9754 in the order they triggered.
9755 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
9756 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
9757 history records.
9758 @end deffn
9759
9760 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
9761 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
9762 they have been triggered.
9763 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
9764 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
9765 and associates it with that identifier.
9766
9767 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
9768 are not related except by this command.
9769 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
9770 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
9771 @end deffn
9772
9773
9774 @node JTAG Commands
9775 @chapter JTAG Commands
9776 @cindex JTAG Commands
9777 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
9778 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
9779 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
9780 may be needed to work with targets which require special
9781 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
9782
9783 To use these commands you will need to understand some
9784 of the basics of JTAG, including:
9785
9786 @itemize @bullet
9787 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
9788 devices such as a CPUs.
9789 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
9790 standard state machine (in parallel)
9791 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
9792 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
9793 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
9794 while the reading previous ones.
9795 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
9796 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
9797 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
9798 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
9799 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
9800 registers.
9801 @end itemize
9802
9803 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
9804
9805 These commands are used by developers who need to access
9806 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
9807 the order of TAP state transitions.
9808 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
9809 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
9810 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
9811 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
9812 these commands are not available.
9813
9814 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
9815 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
9816 that specify the entire register.
9817 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
9818 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
9819 The return value holds the original value of each
9820 of those fields.
9821
9822 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
9823 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
9824 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
9825 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
9826 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
9827
9828 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
9829 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
9830
9831 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
9832 in that state.
9833 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
9834 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
9835 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
9836
9837 @quotation Warning
9838 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
9839 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
9840 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
9841 data registers, which may have different lengths.
9842 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
9843 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
9844 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
9845 (by connecting a different scan chain).
9846 @end quotation
9847 @end deffn
9848
9849 @deffn Command {flush_count}
9850 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
9851 This may be used for performance tuning.
9852
9853 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
9854 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
9855 not change with the amount of data which is written.
9856 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
9857 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
9858 instead of batching them into larger operations.
9859 @end deffn
9860
9861 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
9862 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
9863 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
9864 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
9865 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
9866 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
9867
9868 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
9869 in that state.
9870 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
9871 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
9872 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
9873
9874 @quotation Note
9875 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
9876 register values, unlike data register values.
9877 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
9878 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
9879 @end quotation
9880 @end deffn
9881
9882 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
9883 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
9884 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
9885 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
9886 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
9887 Then, in a series of single state transitions
9888 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
9889 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
9890 The final state must also be stable.
9891 @end deffn
9892
9893 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
9894 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
9895 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
9896 Instructions often need some time
9897 to execute before they take effect.
9898 @end deffn
9899
9900 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
9901 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
9902
9903 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9904 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
9905 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
9906 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
9907 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
9908 @end deffn
9909
9910 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9911 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
9912 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
9913 must also be enabled.
9914 Default is enabled.
9915 @end deffn
9916
9917 @section TAP state names
9918 @cindex TAP state names
9919
9920 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
9921 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
9922 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
9923 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
9924
9925 @itemize @bullet
9926 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
9927 acts as if TRST were pulsed
9928 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
9929 @item @b{DRSELECT}
9930 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
9931 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
9932 through the data register
9933 @item @b{DREXIT1}
9934 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
9935 for update or more shifting
9936 @item @b{DREXIT2}
9937 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
9938 @item @b{IRSELECT}
9939 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
9940 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
9941 through the instruction register
9942 @item @b{IREXIT1}
9943 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
9944 for update or more shifting
9945 @item @b{IREXIT2}
9946 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
9947 @end itemize
9948
9949 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
9950 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
9951 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
9952 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
9953
9954 @itemize @bullet
9955 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
9956 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
9957 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
9958 may not be as expected.
9959 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
9960 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
9961 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
9962 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
9963 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
9964 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
9965 @end itemize
9966
9967 @node Boundary Scan Commands
9968 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
9969
9970 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
9971 boundary scan based hardware testing.
9972 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
9973 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
9974
9975 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
9976 @cindex Serial Vector Format
9977 @cindex SVF
9978
9979 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
9980 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
9981 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
9982 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
9983
9984 @deffn Command {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
9985 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
9986 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
9987 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
9988
9989 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
9990 affect their semantics.
9991
9992 Command options:
9993 @itemize @minus
9994 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
9995 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
9996 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
9997 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
9998 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
9999 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
10000 on the real interface;
10001 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
10002 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
10003 errors.
10004 @end itemize
10005 @end deffn
10006
10007 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10008 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10009 @cindex XSVF
10010
10011 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
10012 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
10013 Xilinx devices.
10014 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10015 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10016
10017 @quotation Important
10018 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
10019 @end quotation
10020
10021 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
10022 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10023 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
10024 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
10025 that TAP.
10026 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
10027 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
10028 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
10029 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
10030 @end deffn
10031
10032 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
10033 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
10034 after building the software.
10035 You may find them useful:
10036
10037 @itemize
10038 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
10039 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
10040 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
10041 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
10042 @end itemize
10043
10044 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
10045 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
10046 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
10047 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
10048 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
10049 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
10050 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
10051
10052
10053 @node Utility Commands
10054 @chapter Utility Commands
10055 @cindex Utility Commands
10056
10057 @section RAM testing
10058 @cindex RAM testing
10059
10060 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
10061 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
10062 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
10063 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
10064 hardware problems.
10065
10066 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
10067 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
10068 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
10069 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
10070
10071 Load the memory testing functions with
10072
10073 @example
10074 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
10075 @end example
10076
10077 to get access to the following facilities:
10078
10079 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
10080 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
10081 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
10082 @end deffn
10083
10084 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
10085 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
10086 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
10087 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
10088 @end deffn
10089
10090 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
10091 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
10092 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
10093 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
10094 @end deffn
10095
10096 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
10097 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
10098 @end deffn
10099
10100 @section Firmware recovery helpers
10101 @cindex Firmware recovery
10102
10103 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
10104 devices recovery with JTAG.
10105
10106 For quickstart instructions run:
10107 @example
10108 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
10109 @end example
10110
10111 @node TFTP
10112 @chapter TFTP
10113 @cindex TFTP
10114 If OpenOCD runs on an embedded host (as ZY1000 does), then TFTP can
10115 be used to access files on PCs (either the developer's PC or some other PC).
10116
10117 The way this works on the ZY1000 is to prefix a filename by
10118 "/tftp/ip/" and append the TFTP path on the TFTP
10119 server (tftpd). For example,
10120
10121 @example
10122 load_image /tftp/10.0.0.96/c:\temp\abc.elf
10123 @end example
10124
10125 will load c:\temp\abc.elf from the developer pc (10.0.0.96) into memory as
10126 if the file was hosted on the embedded host.
10127
10128 In order to achieve decent performance, you must choose a TFTP server
10129 that supports a packet size bigger than the default packet size (512 bytes). There
10130 are numerous TFTP servers out there (free and commercial) and you will have to do
10131 a bit of googling to find something that fits your requirements.
10132
10133 @node GDB and OpenOCD
10134 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
10135 @cindex GDB
10136 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
10137 to debug remote targets.
10138 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
10139
10140 @itemize
10141 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
10142 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
10143 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
10144 as shown in this chapter.
10145 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
10146 that also will probably need to be configured.
10147 @end itemize
10148
10149 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
10150 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
10151 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
10152 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
10153 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
10154 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
10155
10156 @section Connecting to GDB
10157 @cindex Connecting to GDB
10158 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
10159 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
10160 errors, which has since been fixed; see
10161 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
10162
10163 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
10164
10165 @enumerate
10166 @item
10167 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
10168 @example
10169 target remote localhost:3333
10170 @end example
10171 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
10172
10173 It is also possible to use the GDB extended remote protocol as follows:
10174 @example
10175 target extended-remote localhost:3333
10176 @end example
10177 @item
10178 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
10179 @example
10180 target remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
10181 @end example
10182 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
10183 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
10184 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
10185 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
10186 @end enumerate
10187
10188 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
10189 GDB command line.
10190
10191 @section Sample GDB session startup
10192
10193 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
10194 than they do when you're debugging locally.
10195 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
10196 small ARM program.
10197 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
10198 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
10199
10200 @example
10201 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
10202 (gdb) target remote localhost:3333
10203 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
10204 ...
10205 (gdb) monitor reset halt
10206 ...
10207 (gdb) load
10208 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
10209 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
10210 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
10211 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
10212 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
10213 (gdb) continue
10214 Continuing.
10215 ...
10216 @end example
10217
10218 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
10219 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
10220 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
10221 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
10222
10223 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
10224
10225 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
10226 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
10227 packet size and the device's memory map.
10228 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
10229 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
10230 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
10231
10232 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
10233 You may need to set those up by hand.
10234 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
10235 something like:
10236
10237 @example
10238 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
10239 @end example
10240
10241 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
10242
10243 @example
10244 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
10245 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
10246 @end example
10247
10248 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
10249 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
10250 do not have such restrictions.
10251
10252 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
10253 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
10254 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
10255 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
10256
10257 @section Programming using GDB
10258 @cindex Programming using GDB
10259 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
10260
10261 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
10262 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
10263 @example
10264 gdb_memory_map disable
10265 @end example
10266 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
10267 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
10268 working area.
10269
10270 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
10271 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
10272 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
10273 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
10274
10275 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
10276 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
10277
10278 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
10279 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
10280 @example
10281 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
10282 @end example
10283
10284 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
10285 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
10286
10287 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
10288 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
10289 will be used.
10290
10291 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
10292 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
10293 @example
10294 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
10295 @end example
10296 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
10297
10298 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
10299 can be used.
10300
10301 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10302 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10303 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
10304
10305 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
10306 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
10307 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
10308
10309 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
10310 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
10311 and GDB treats it as it were running.
10312 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
10313 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
10314 without any intrusion of the target process.
10315
10316 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
10317 Place following command after target configuration:
10318 @example
10319 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
10320 @end example
10321
10322 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
10323 switch off gdb_memory_map:
10324 @example
10325 gdb_memory_map disable
10326 @end example
10327
10328 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
10329 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
10330 @example
10331 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
10332 @end example
10333
10334 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
10335 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
10336
10337 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target remote ...} and inspect memory
10338 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
10339 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
10340 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
10341
10342 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
10343 previously shown varibles.
10344
10345 @section RTOS Support
10346 @cindex RTOS Support
10347 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
10348
10349 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
10350 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
10351
10352 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
10353 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
10354 GDB commands.
10355
10356 @* An example setup is below:
10357
10358 @example
10359 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
10360 @end example
10361
10362 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
10363
10364 Currently supported rtos's include:
10365 @itemize @bullet
10366 @item @option{eCos}
10367 @item @option{ThreadX}
10368 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
10369 @item @option{linux}
10370 @item @option{ChibiOS}
10371 @item @option{embKernel}
10372 @item @option{mqx}
10373 @item @option{uCOS-III}
10374 @item @option{nuttx}
10375 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
10376 @end itemize
10377
10378 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
10379 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
10380
10381 @table @code
10382 @item eCos symbols
10383 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
10384 @item ThreadX symbols
10385 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
10386 @item FreeRTOS symbols
10387 @c The following is taken from recent texinfo to provide compatibility
10388 @c with ancient versions that do not support @raggedright
10389 @tex
10390 \begingroup
10391 \rightskip0pt plus2em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
10392 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
10393 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
10394 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
10395 \par
10396 \endgroup
10397 @end tex
10398 @item linux symbols
10399 init_task.
10400 @item ChibiOS symbols
10401 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
10402 @item embKernel symbols
10403 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
10404 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
10405 @item mqx symbols
10406 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
10407 @item uC/OS-III symbols
10408 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty
10409 @item nuttx symbols
10410 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable
10411 @end table
10412
10413 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
10414 some, eg. FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III, extra steps must be taken.
10415
10416 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
10417 along with the project:
10418
10419 @table @code
10420 @item FreeRTOS
10421 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
10422 @item uC/OS-III
10423 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
10424 @end table
10425
10426 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
10427 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
10428 @cindex SMP
10429 @cindex RTOS
10430 @cindex hwthread
10431 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
10432 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
10433 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
10434 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
10435 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
10436 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
10437 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
10438 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
10439 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
10440
10441 @section Legacy SMP core switching support
10442 @quotation Note
10443 This method is deprecated in favor of the @emph{hwthread} pseudo RTOS.
10444 @end quotation
10445
10446 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
10447 @itemize @bullet
10448 @item j - smp status request
10449 @item J - smp set request
10450 @end itemize
10451
10452 OpenOCD implements :
10453 @itemize @bullet
10454 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
10455 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
10456 @option{E01} for target not smp.
10457 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
10458 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
10459 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
10460 @end itemize
10461
10462 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
10463 @itemize @bullet
10464 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
10465 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
10466 @example
10467 set $_core 1
10468 #Jc01 packet is sent
10469 print $_core
10470 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
10471 @end example
10472
10473 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
10474 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
10475
10476 @example
10477 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
10478 define toggle0
10479 maint packet Jc0
10480 continue
10481 main packet Jc-1
10482 end
10483 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
10484 define toggle1
10485 maint packet Jc1
10486 continue
10487 main packet Jc-1
10488 end
10489 @end example
10490 @end itemize
10491
10492 @node Tcl Scripting API
10493 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
10494 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
10495 @cindex Tcl scripts
10496 @section API rules
10497
10498 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
10499 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
10500 of state information as an argument to each proc.
10501
10502 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
10503 pair list and lists.
10504
10505 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
10506 list.
10507
10508 @example
10509 > set foo(me) Duane
10510 > set foo(you) Oyvind
10511 > set foo(mouse) Micky
10512 > set foo(duck) Donald
10513 @end example
10514
10515 If one does this:
10516
10517 @example
10518 > set foo
10519 @end example
10520
10521 The result is:
10522
10523 @example
10524 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
10525 @end example
10526
10527 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
10528
10529 @verbatim
10530 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
10531 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
10532 }
10533 @end verbatim
10534
10535 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
10536 should be passed in to the proc in question.
10537
10538 @section Internal low-level Commands
10539
10540 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
10541 invoke directly.
10542
10543 @itemize @bullet
10544 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
10545
10546 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
10547 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
10548
10549 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
10550 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
10551
10552 Return information about the flash banks
10553
10554 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
10555
10556 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
10557 its execution. Example:
10558
10559 @example
10560 > capture "reset init"
10561 @end example
10562
10563 @end itemize
10564
10565 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
10566 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
10567 called "flash_banks".
10568
10569 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
10570
10571 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
10572 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
10573 holds one of the following values:
10574
10575 @itemize @bullet
10576 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
10577 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating system.
10578 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
10579 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
10580 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
10581 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating system
10582 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
10583 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
10584 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
10585 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
10586 @end itemize
10587
10588 Note: 'winxx' was chosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
10589
10590 @quotation Note
10591 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
10592 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
10593 @code{jim_platform} (because it
10594 is jim, not real tcl).
10595 @end quotation
10596
10597 @section Tcl RPC server
10598 @cindex RPC
10599
10600 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
10601 commands and receive the results.
10602
10603 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
10604 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
10605 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
10606 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
10607 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
10608
10609 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
10610 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
10611 @command{capture} command.
10612
10613 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
10614
10615 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
10616 @cindex RPC Notifications
10617
10618 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
10619 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
10620
10621 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
10622 in the following format.
10623
10624 @verbatim
10625 type target_event event [event-name]
10626 type target_state state [state-name]
10627 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
10628 @end verbatim
10629
10630 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
10631 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
10632 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
10633 Defaults to off.
10634
10635 @end deffn
10636
10637 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
10638 @cindex RPC trace output
10639
10640 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
10641 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
10642
10643 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
10644
10645 @verbatim
10646 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
10647 @end verbatim
10648
10649 @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
10650 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
10651 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
10652 Defaults to off.
10653
10654 See an example application here:
10655 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
10656
10657 @end deffn
10658
10659 @node FAQ
10660 @chapter FAQ
10661 @cindex faq
10662 @enumerate
10663 @anchor{faqrtck}
10664 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
10665 @cindex RTCK
10666 @cindex adaptive clocking
10667 @*
10668
10669 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
10670 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
10671 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
10672 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
10673
10674 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
10675 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
10676 for example. There are 2 basic options:
10677 @enumerate
10678 @item
10679 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
10680 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
10681 @item
10682 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
10683 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
10684 @end enumerate
10685
10686 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
10687 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
10688 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
10689 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
10690 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
10691 power).
10692
10693 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
10694 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
10695 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
10696 ARM926 scenario).
10697 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
10698 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
10699 JTAG can use a faster clock.
10700
10701 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
10702 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
10703 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
10704 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
10705
10706 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
10707
10708 In order to make use of this,
10709 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
10710 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
10711
10712 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
10713 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
10714 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
10715 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
10716 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
10717
10718 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
10719 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
10720 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
10721 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
10722
10723 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
10724 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
10725 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
10726 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
10727 with a CPLD.
10728 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
10729 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
10730 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
10731 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
10732 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
10733 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
10734
10735 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
10736
10737 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
10738
10739 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
10740 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
10741 depending on the chips on your board.
10742 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
10743 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
10744 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
10745
10746 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
10747 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
10748 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
10749
10750 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
10751 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
10752 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
10753 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
10754
10755 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
10756 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
10757 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
10758 this way.
10759
10760 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
10761 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
10762 clock rate.
10763 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
10764 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
10765 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
10766
10767 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
10768
10769 @example
10770 # Example: 1.234MHz
10771 adapter speed 1234
10772 @end example
10773
10774
10775 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
10776
10777 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
10778 around Windows filenames.
10779
10780 @example
10781 > echo \a
10782
10783 > echo @{\a@}
10784 \a
10785 > echo "\a"
10786
10787 >
10788 @end example
10789
10790
10791 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
10792
10793 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
10794 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
10795 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
10796
10797 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
10798 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
10799 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
10800
10801 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
10802 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
10803 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
10804
10805 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
10806
10807 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
10808 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
10809 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
10810 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
10811
10812 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
10813 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
10814 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
10815
10816 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
10817 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
10818
10819 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
10820 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
10821 memory read caused data abort".
10822
10823 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
10824 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
10825 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
10826 be done, feel free to add this here.
10827
10828 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
10829 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
10830 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
10831 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
10832 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
10833 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
10834 gracefully stops.
10835
10836 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
10837 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
10838 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
10839
10840 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
10841 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
10842 bytes. Painful...
10843
10844
10845 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
10846 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
10847
10848 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
10849 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
10850 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
10851 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
10852 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
10853 reset, everything else should work fine.
10854
10855 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
10856 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
10857 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
10858 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
10859
10860 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
10861 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
10862 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
10863 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
10864
10865 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
10866
10867 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
10868 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
10869 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
10870
10871 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
10872 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
10873
10874 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
10875 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
10876 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
10877 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
10878 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
10879 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
10880 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
10881 clock frequency?
10882
10883 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
10884 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
10885 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
10886 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
10887 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
10888
10889 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
10890
10891 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
10892 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
10893 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
10894 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
10895 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
10896 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
10897 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
10898
10899 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
10900
10901 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
10902 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
10903 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
10904 up DRAM and loading it with code.
10905
10906 @anchor{faqtaporder}
10907 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
10908 particular order?
10909
10910 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
10911 the same order used by the hardware.
10912
10913 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
10914 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
10915 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
10916 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
10917 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
10918 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
10919
10920 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
10921 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
10922 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
10923 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
10924
10925 @itemize @bullet
10926 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
10927 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
10928 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
10929 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
10930 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
10931 @end itemize
10932
10933 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
10934
10935 @itemize @bullet
10936 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
10937 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
10938 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
10939 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
10940 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
10941 @end itemize
10942
10943
10944 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
10945 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
10946 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
10947
10948 TODO.
10949
10950 @end enumerate
10951
10952 @node Tcl Crash Course
10953 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
10954 @cindex Tcl
10955
10956 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
10957 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
10958 how the Tcl scripts work.
10959
10960 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
10961 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
10962 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
10963 OpenOCD.
10964
10965 @section Tcl Rule #1
10966 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
10967 @enumerate
10968 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
10969 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10970 @end enumerate
10971
10972 The Tcl equal is this:
10973
10974 @enumerate
10975 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
10976 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10977 @end enumerate
10978
10979 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
10980 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
10981
10982 @section Tcl Rule #1b
10983 There is a second pair of rules.
10984 @enumerate
10985 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
10986 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
10987 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
10988 in Tcl.
10989 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10990 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
10991 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
10992 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
10993 @end enumerate
10994
10995 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
10996 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
10997 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
10998 Everything is a string}
10999
11000 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
11001 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
11002 difference is subtle.
11003 @enumerate
11004 @item Parse Time
11005 @item Evaluation Time
11006 @end enumerate
11007
11008 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
11009 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
11010 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
11011
11012 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
11013 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
11014 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
11015 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
11016
11017 @itemize @bullet
11018 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
11019 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
11020 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
11021 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
11022 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
11023 @example
11024 # bash example
11025 X=`date`
11026 echo "The Date is: $X"
11027 # Tcl example
11028 set X [date]
11029 puts "The Date is: $X"
11030 @end example
11031 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
11032 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
11033 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
11034 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
11035 is a string}
11036 @example
11037 set x "Dinner"
11038 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
11039 @end example
11040 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
11041 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
11042 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
11043 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
11044 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
11045 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
11046 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
11047 @end itemize
11048
11049 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
11050
11051 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
11052
11053 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
11054
11055 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
11056 the normal way.
11057
11058 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
11059 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
11060 line is immediately executed.
11061
11062 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
11063 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
11064
11065 @subsection Command Execution
11066
11067 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
11068 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
11069 control flow operators.
11070
11071 Commands are executed like this:
11072
11073 @enumerate
11074 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
11075 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
11076 @item Repeat until End Of File.
11077 @end enumerate
11078
11079 It sort of works like this:
11080 @example
11081 for(;;)@{
11082 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
11083
11084 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
11085
11086 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
11087 @}
11088 @end example
11089
11090 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
11091 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
11092 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
11093 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
11094 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
11095 ``LookupCommand()''
11096
11097 @subsection The FOR command
11098
11099 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
11100 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
11101 command just like any other command.
11102
11103 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
11104 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
11105 are:
11106
11107 @enumerate 0
11108 @item The ascii text 'for'
11109 @item The start text
11110 @item The test expression
11111 @item The next text
11112 @item The body text
11113 @end enumerate
11114
11115 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
11116 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
11117 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
11118 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
11119
11120 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
11121 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
11122
11123 @example
11124 int
11125 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
11126 int *argc,
11127 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
11128 @end example
11129
11130 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
11131 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
11132 still operates in the same basic way.
11133
11134 @subsection FOR command implementation
11135
11136 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
11137 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
11138
11139 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
11140
11141 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
11142
11143 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
11144 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
11145 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
11146
11147 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
11148 expression and returns a value.
11149
11150 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
11151 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
11152 @example
11153 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
11154
11155 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
11156
11157 int
11158 MyForCommand( void *interp,
11159 int argc,
11160 char **argv )
11161 @{
11162 if( argc != 5 )@{
11163 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
11164 return ERROR;
11165 @}
11166
11167 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
11168
11169 // Execute the start statement.
11170 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
11171
11172 // Top of loop test
11173 for(;;)@{
11174 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
11175 if( i == 0 )
11176 break;
11177
11178 // Execute the body
11179 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
11180
11181 // Execute the LOOP part
11182 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
11183 @}
11184
11185 // Return no error
11186 SetResult( interp, "" );
11187 return SUCCESS;
11188 @}
11189 @end example
11190
11191 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
11192 in the same basic way.
11193
11194 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
11195
11196 @subsection source and find commands
11197 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
11198 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
11199 @*Remember the parsing rules
11200 @enumerate
11201 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
11202 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
11203 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
11204 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
11205 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
11206 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
11207 That character begins Tcl comments.)
11208 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
11209 it reads a file and executes as a script.
11210 @end enumerate
11211 @subsection format command
11212 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
11213 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
11214 @b{sprintf()}.
11215 @b{Example}
11216 @example
11217 set x 6
11218 set y 7
11219 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
11220 @end example
11221 @enumerate
11222 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
11223 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
11224 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
11225 @* Refer to Rule #1
11226 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
11227 @* Refer to Rule #1.
11228 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
11229 @end enumerate
11230 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
11231 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
11232 @example
11233 #1 Good
11234 proc someproc @{@} @{
11235 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
11236 @}
11237 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
11238 #2 Good - no variables
11239 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
11240 #3 Good Curly Braces
11241 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
11242 puts "Time: [date]"
11243 @}
11244 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
11245 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
11246 @end example
11247 @enumerate
11248 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
11249 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
11250 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
11251 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
11252 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
11253 command.
11254 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
11255 @*There are 4 examples:
11256 @enumerate
11257 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
11258 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
11259 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
11260 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
11261 @end enumerate
11262
11263 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
11264 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
11265 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
11266
11267 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
11268 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
11269 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
11270 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
11271 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
11272 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
11273 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
11274 @end enumerate
11275 @subsection Global Variables
11276 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
11277 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
11278 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
11279 @example
11280 proc myproc @{ @} @{
11281 set y 0 #Local variable Y
11282 global x #Global variable X
11283 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
11284 @}
11285 @end example
11286 @section Other Tcl Hacks
11287 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
11288 @example
11289 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
11290 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
11291 # Create var name
11292 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
11293 # Make it a global
11294 global $vn
11295 # Set it.
11296 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
11297 @}
11298 @end example
11299 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
11300 @example
11301 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
11302 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
11303 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
11304 @}
11305 @end example
11306
11307 @include fdl.texi
11308
11309 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
11310 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
11311 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
11312 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
11313 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
11314 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
11315
11316 @printindex cp
11317
11318 @node Command and Driver Index
11319 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
11320 @printindex fn
11321
11322 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)